Connection Manual: Series
Connection Manual: Series
Connection Manual: Series
Connection Manual
(Microcomputers, MODBUS Products, Peripherals) for GT Works3
MICROCOMPUTER CONNECTION
MODBUS/RTU CONNECTION
MODBUS/TCP CONNECTION
CONNECTION TO SOUND OUTPUT UNIT
CONNECTION TO EXTERNAL I/O DEVICE
FINGERPRINT AUTHENTICATION DEVICE CONNECTION
BAR CODE READER CONNECTION
REMOTE PERSONAL COMPUTER OPERATION CONNECTION
VNC(R) SERVER CONNECTION
VIDEO/RGB CONNECTION
PRINTER CONNECTION
MULTIMEDIA CONNECTION
RFID CONNECTION
SAFETY PRECAUTIONS
(Always read these precautions before using this equipment.)
Before using this product, please read this manual and the relevant manuals introduced in this manual
carefully and pay full attention to safety to handle the product correctly.
The precautions given in this manual are concerned with this product.
In this manual, the safety precautions are ranked as "WARNING" and "CAUTION".
Note that the caution level may lead to a serious accident according to the circumstances.
Always follow the instructions of both levels because they are important to personal safety.
Please save this manual to make it accessible when required and always forward it to the end user.
[DESIGN PRECAUTIONS]
WARNING
● Some failures of the GOT, communication unit or cable may keep the outputs on or off.
Some failures of a touch panel may cause malfunction of the input objects such as a touch switch.
An external monitoring circuit should be provided to check for output signals which may lead to a
serious accident.
Not doing so can cause an accident due to false output or malfunction.
● If a communication fault (including cable disconnection) occurs during monitoring on the GOT,
communication between the GOT and PLC CPU is suspended and the GOT becomes inoperative.
For bus connection : The CPU becomes faulty and the GOT becomes inoperative.
For other than bus connection : The GOT becomes inoperative.
A system where the GOT is used should be configured to perform any significant operation to the
system by using the switches of a device other than the GOT on the assumption that a GOT
communication fault will occur.
Not doing so can cause an accident due to false output or malfunction.
● Do not use the GOT as the warning device that may cause a serious accident.
An independent and redundant hardware or mechanical interlock is required to configure the device
that displays and outputs serious warning.
Failure to observe this instruction may result in an accident due to incorrect output or malfunction.
A-1
[DESIGN PRECAUTIONS]
WARNING
● Incorrect operation of the touch switch(s) may lead to a serious accident if the GOT backlight is gone
out.
When the GOT backlight goes out, the display section dims, while the input of the touch switch(s)
remains active.
This may confuse an operator in thinking that the GOT is in "screensaver" mode, who then tries to
release the GOT from this mode by touching the display section, which may cause a touch switch to
operate.
Note that the following occurs on the GOT when the backlight goes out.
<When using the GT1655-V, Handy GOT, GT15, GT14, GT12, GT11, or GT105 >
The POWER LED blinks (green/orange) and the monitor screen appears blank.
<When using the GT1695, GT1685, GT1675, GT1672, GT1665, or GT1662>
The POWER LED blinks (green/orange) and the monitor screen appears dimmed.
<When using the GT104 >
The monitor screen appears blank.
<When using the GT103 or GT102 >
The monitor screen appears dimmed.
● The display section of the GT16, GT1595-X, GT14, GT12 or GT1020 are an analog-resistive type
touch panel.
If you touch the display section simultaneously in 2 points or more, the switch that is located around
the center of the touched point, if any, may operate.
Do not touch the display section in 2 points or more simultaneously.
Doing so may cause an accident due to incorrect output or malfunction.
● When programs or parameters of the controller (such as a PLC) that is monitored by the GOT are
changed, be sure to reset the GOT or shut off the power of the GOT at the same time.
Not doing so can cause an accident due to false output or malfunction.
● To maintain the safety of the system incorporating the GOT, take measures against unauthorized
access from external devices via a network.
To maintain the safety against unauthorized access via the Internet, take measures such as installing
a firewall.
A-2
[DESIGN PRECAUTIONS]
CAUTION
● Do not bundle the control and communication cables with main-circuit, power or other wiring.
Run the above cables separately from such wiring and keep them a minimum of 100mm apart.
Not doing so noise can cause a malfunction.
● Do not press the GOT display section with a pointed material as a pen or driver.
Doing so can result in a damage or failure of the display section.
● When the GOT is connected to the Ethernet network, the available IP address is restricted according
to the system configuration.
• When multiple GOTs are connected to the Ethernet network:
Do not set the IP address (192.168.0.18) for the GOTs and the controllers in the network.
• When a single GOT is connected to the Ethernet network:
Do not set the IP address (192.168.0.18) for the controllers except the GOT in the network.
Doing so can cause the IP address duplication. The duplication can negatively affect the
communication of the device with the IP address (192.168.0.18).
The operation at the IP address duplication depends on the devices and the system.
● Turn on the controllers and the network devices to be ready for communication before they
communicate with the GOT.
Failure to do so can cause a communication error on the GOT.
A-3
[MOUNTING PRECAUTIONS]
WARNING
● Be sure to shut off all phases of the external power supply used by the system before mounting or
removing the GOT to/from the panel.
Not switching the power off in all phases can cause a unit failure or malfunction.
● Be sure to shut off all phases of the external power supply used by the system before mounting or
removing the communication unit, option function board or multi-color display board onto/from the
GOT.
Not doing so can cause the unit to fail or malfunction.
● Before mounting an optional function board or Multi-color display board, wear a static discharge wrist
strap to prevent the board from being damaged by static electricity.
CAUTION
● Use the GOT in the environment that satisfies the general specifications described in the User's
Manual.
Not doing so can cause an electric shock, fire, malfunction or product damage or deterioration.
● When mounting the GOT to the control panel, tighten the mounting screws in the specified torque
range.
Undertightening can cause the GOT to drop, short circuit or malfunction.
Overtightening can cause a drop, short circuit or malfunction due to the damage of the screws or the
GOT.
● When loading the communication unit or option unit to the GOT (GT16, GT15), fit it to the extension
interface of the GOT and tighten the mounting screws in the specified torque range.
Undertightening can cause the GOT to drop, short circuit or malfunction.
Overtightening can cause a drop, failure or malfunction due to the damage of the screws or unit.
● When mounting the multi-color display board onto the GOT (GT15), connect it to the corresponding
connector securely and tighten the mounting screws within the specified torque range.
Loose tightening may cause the unit and/or GOT to malfunction due to poor contact.
Overtightening may damage the screws, unit and/or GOT; they might malfunction.
● When mounting the option function board onto the GOT (GT16), connect it to the corresponding
connector securely and tighten the mounting screws within the specified torque range.
● When mounting an optional function board onto the GOT(GT15), fully connect it to the connector
until you hear a click.
● When mounting an optional function board onto the GOT(GT11), fully connect it to the connector.
● When inserting a CF card into the GOT(GT16, GT15, GT11), push it into the CF card interface of
GOT until the CF card eject button will pop out.
Failure to do so may cause a malfunction due to poor contact.
● When inserting/removing a SD card into/from the GOT(GT14), turn the SD card access switch off in
advance.
Failure to do so may corrupt data within the SD card.
A-4
[MOUNTING PRECAUTIONS]
CAUTION
● When inserting/removing a CF card into/from the GOT(GT16, GT15, GT11), turn the CF card access
switch off in advance.
Failure to do so may corrupt data within the CF card.
● When removing a SD card from the GOT(GT14), make sure to support the SD card by hand, as it may
pop out.
Failure to do so may cause the SD card to drop from the GOT and break.
● When removing a CF card from the GOT, make sure to support the CF card by hand, as it may pop out.
Failure to do so may cause the CF card to drop from the GOT and break.
● When installing a USB memory to the GOT(GT16, GT14), make sure to install the USB memory to
the USB interface firmly.
Failure to do so may cause a malfunction due to poor contact.
● Before removing the USB memory from the GOT(GT16, GT14), operate the utility screen for removal.
After the successful completion dialog box is displayed, remove the memory by hand carefully.
Failure to do so may cause the USB memory to drop, resulting in a damage or failure of the memory.
● For closing the USB environmental protection cover, fix the cover by pushing the mark on the latch
firmly to comply with the protective structure.
● Operate and store the GOT in environments without direct sunlight, high temperature, dust, humidity,
and vibrations.
● When using the GOT in the environment of oil or chemicals, use the protective cover for oil.
Failure to do so may cause failure or malfunction due to the oil or chemical entering into the GOT.
[WIRING PRECAUTIONS]
WARNING
● Be sure to shut off all phases of the external power supply used by the system before wiring.
Failure to do so may result in an electric shock, product damage or malfunctions.
● Please make sure to ground FG terminal and LG terminal and protective ground terminal of the GOT
power supply section by applying Class D Grounding (Class 3 Grounding Method) or higher which is
used exclusively for the GOT.
Not doing so may cause an electric shock or malfunction.
● Be sure to tighten any unused terminal screws with a torque of 0.5 to 0.8N•m.
Failure to do so may cause a short circuit due to contact with a solderless terminal.
● Use applicable solderless terminals and tighten them with the specified torque.
If any solderless spade terminal is used, it may be disconnected when the terminal screw comes
loose, resulting in failure.
A-5
[WIRING PRECAUTIONS]
CAUTION
● Correctly wire the GOT power supply section after confirming the rated voltage and terminal
arrangement of the product.
Not doing so can cause a fire or failure.
● Tighten the terminal screws of the GOT power supply section in the specified torque range.
Undertightening can cause a short circuit or malfunction.
Overtightening can cause a short circuit or malfunction due to the damage of the screws or the GOT.
● Exercise care to avoid foreign matter such as chips and wire offcuts entering the GOT.
Not doing so can cause a fire, failure or malfunction.
● The module has an ingress prevention label on its top to prevent foreign matter, such as wire offcuts,
from entering the module during wiring.
Do not peel this label during wiring.
Before starting system operation, be sure to peel this label because of heat dissipation.
● Plug the bus connection cable by inserting it into the connector of the connected unit until it "clicks".
After plugging, check that it has been inserted snugly.
Not doing so can cause a malfunction due to a contact fault.
● Plug the communication cable into the connector of the connected unit and tighten the mounting and
terminal screws in the specified torque range.
Undertightening can cause a short circuit or malfunction.
Overtightening can cause a short circuit or malfunction due to the damage of the screws or unit.
● Plug the QnA/ACPU/Motion controller (A series) bus connection cable by inserting it into the
connector of the connected unit until it "clicks".
After plugging, check that it has been inserted snugly.
Not doing so can cause a malfunction due to a contact fault.
A-6
[TEST OPERATION PRECAUTIONS]
WARNING
● Before performing the test operations of the user creation monitor screen (such as turning ON or
OFF bit device, changing the word device current value, changing the settings or current values of
the timer or counter, and changing the buffer memory current value), read through the manual
carefully and make yourself familiar with the operation method.
During test operation, never change the data of the devices which are used to perform significant
operation for the system.
False output or malfunction can cause an accident.
[STARTUP/MAINTENANCE PRECAUTIONS]
WARNING
● When power is on, do not touch the terminals.
Doing so can cause an electric shock or malfunction.
● Before starting cleaning or terminal screw retightening, always switch off the power externally in all
phases.
Not switching the power off in all phases can cause a unit failure or malfunction.
Undertightening can cause a short circuit or malfunction.
Overtightening can cause a short circuit or malfunction due to the damage of the screws or unit.
A-7
[STARTUP/MAINTENANCE PRECAUTIONS]
CAUTION
● Do not disassemble or modify the unit.
Doing so can cause a failure, malfunction, injury or fire.
● Do not touch the conductive and electronic parts of the unit directly.
Doing so can cause a unit malfunction or failure.
● When unplugging the cable connected to the unit, do not hold and pull the cable portion.
Doing so can cause the unit or cable to be damaged or can cause a malfunction due to a cable
connection fault.
● Before touching the unit, always touch grounded metal, etc. to discharge static electricity from
human body, etc.
Not doing so can cause the unit to fail or malfunction.
● When any difference between a touched position and the object position occurs, other object may be
activated. This may cause an unexpected operation due to incorrect output or malfunction.
A-8
[BACKLIGHT REPLACEMENT PRECAUTIONS]
WARNING
● Be sure to shut off all phases of the external power supply of the GOT (and the PLC CPU in the case
of a bus topology) and remove the GOT from the control panel before replacing the backlight (when
using the GOT with the backlight replaceable by the user).
Not doing so can cause an electric shock.
Replacing a backlight without removing the GOT from the control panel can cause the backlight or
control panel to drop, resulting in an injury.
CAUTION
● Wear gloves for the backlight replacement when using the GOT with the backlight replaceable by the
user.
Not doing so can cause an injury.
● Before replacing a backlight, allow 5 minutes or more after turning off the GOT when using the GOT
with the backlight replaceable by the user.
Not doing so can cause a burn from heat of the backlight.
[DISPOSAL PRECAUTIONS]
CAUTION
● When disposing of the product, handle it as industrial waste.
● When disposing of this product, treat it as industrial waste. When disposing of batteries, separate
them from other wastes according to the local regulations.
(For details of the battery directive in EU member states, refer to the User's Manual of the GOT to be
used.)
[TRANSPORTATION PRECAUTIONS]
CAUTION
● When transporting lithium batteries, make sure to treat them based on the transport regulations.
(For details on models subject to restrictions, refer to the User's Manual for the GOT you are using.)
● Make sure to transport the GOT main unit and/or relevant unit(s) in the manner they will not be
exposed to the impact exceeding the impact resistance described in the general specifications of the
User's Manual, as they are precision devices.
Failure to do so may cause the unit to fail.
Check if the unit operates correctly after transportation.
A-9
INTRODUCTION
Thank you for choosing Mitsubishi Electric Graphic Operation Terminal (Mitsubishi Electric GOT).
Read this manual and make sure you understand the functions and performance of the GOT thoroughly
in advance to ensure correct use.
CONTENTS
A - 10
MICROCOMPUTER CONNECTION
2. MICROCOMPUTER CONNECTION (SERIAL)
2.1 Microcomputer Connection (Serial) ................................................................................................. 2 - 2
2.2 System Configuration ...................................................................................................................... 2 - 4
2.2.1 For the microcomputer connection (serial) ........................................................................... 2 - 4
2.3 Connection Diagram ........................................................................................................................ 2 - 6
2.3.1 RS-232 cable ........................................................................................................................ 2 - 6
2.3.2 RS-422 cable ........................................................................................................................ 2 - 8
2.4 Device Data Area........................................................................................................................... 2 - 10
2.4.1 D devices ............................................................................................................................ 2 - 11
2.4.2 R devices ............................................................................................................................ 2 - 15
2.4.3 L devices ............................................................................................................................ 2 - 16
2.4.4 M devices ........................................................................................................................... 2 - 17
2.4.5 SD devices ......................................................................................................................... 2 - 18
2.4.6 SM devices ......................................................................................................................... 2 - 21
2.5 Message Formats .......................................................................................................................... 2 - 23
2.5.1 Data format type and application ........................................................................................ 2 - 23
2.5.2 List of commands ............................................................................................................... 2 - 25
2.5.3 Formats 1, 2 (GOT-A900 Series microcomputer connection) ............................................ 2 - 28
2.5.4 Formats 3 to 6 (A compatible 1C frame) ............................................................................ 2 - 41
2.5.5 Formats 7 to 10 (QnA compatible 3C/4C frame) ................................................................ 2 - 46
2.5.6 Formats 11 to 13 (Digital Electronics Corporation's memory link method)......................... 2 - 54
2.5.7 Formats 14, 15 (GOT-F900 Series microcomputer connection)......................................... 2 - 63
2.6 GOT Side Settings......................................................................................................................... 2 - 77
2.6.1 Setting communication interface (Communication settings)............................................... 2 - 77
2.6.2 Communication detail settings............................................................................................ 2 - 78
2.7 System Configuration Examples.................................................................................................... 2 - 79
2.8 Device Range that Can Be Set...................................................................................................... 2 - 82
2.9 Precautions.................................................................................................................................... 2 - 83
A - 11
3.4.6 Formats 6, 7 (4E frame)...................................................................................................... 3 - 50
3.4.7 Formats 8, 9 (QnA compatible 3E frame) ........................................................................... 3 - 60
3.5 GOT Side Settings ......................................................................................................................... 3 - 69
3.5.1 Setting communication interface (Communication settings)............................................... 3 - 69
3.5.2 Communication detail settings............................................................................................ 3 - 69
3.6 System Configuration Examples.................................................................................................... 3 - 72
3.7 Device Range that Can Be Set ...................................................................................................... 3 - 73
3.8 Precautions .................................................................................................................................... 3 - 74
MODBUS CONNECTIONS
4. MODBUS(R)/RTU CONNECTION
4.1 Connectable Model List ................................................................................................................... 4 - 2
4.2 System Configuration ...................................................................................................................... 4 - 3
4.2.1 Connecting to MODBUS(R)/RTU equipment........................................................................ 4 - 3
4.3 Connection Diagram ........................................................................................................................ 4 - 4
4.3.1 RS-232 cable ........................................................................................................................ 4 - 4
4.3.2 RS-422/485 cable ................................................................................................................. 4 - 5
4.4 GOT Side Settings ......................................................................................................................... 4 - 12
4.4.1 Setting communication interface (Communication settings)............................................... 4 - 12
4.4.2 Communication detail settings............................................................................................ 4 - 12
4.5 MODBUS(R)/RTU Equipment Side Setting ................................................................................... 4 - 14
4.5.1 Communication settings ..................................................................................................... 4 - 14
4.5.2 Station number setting........................................................................................................ 4 - 17
4.6 Precautions .................................................................................................................................... 4 - 18
5. MODBUS(R)/TCP CONNECTION
5.1 Connectable Model List ................................................................................................................... 5 - 2
5.2 System Configuration ...................................................................................................................... 5 - 2
5.2.1 Connecting to MODBUS(R)/TCP equipment........................................................................ 5 - 2
5.3 GOT Side Settings ........................................................................................................................... 5 - 3
5.3.1 Setting communication interface (Communication settings)................................................. 5 - 3
5.3.2 Communication detail settings.............................................................................................. 5 - 3
5.3.3 Ethernet setting..................................................................................................................... 5 - 5
5.4 MODBUS(R)/TCP Equipment Setting ............................................................................................. 5 - 6
5.5 Device Range that Can Be Set ........................................................................................................ 5 - 6
5.6 Example of Connection.................................................................................................................. 5 - 10
5.6.1 Connecting to SCHNEIDER PLC (Modicon Premium series and Modicon Quantum
series) ................................................................................................................................. 5 - 10
5.6.2 Connecting to YOKOGAWA PLC (STARDOM).................................................................. 5 - 12
5.7 Precautions .................................................................................................................................... 5 - 15
A - 12
6.2 System Configuration ...................................................................................................................... 6 - 2
6.2.1 Connecting to sound output unit ........................................................................................... 6 - 2
6.3 GOT Side Settings........................................................................................................................... 6 - 3
6.3.1 Setting communication interface .......................................................................................... 6 - 3
6.4 Precautions...................................................................................................................................... 6 - 4
A - 13
10.3 Ethernet Connection ...................................................................................................................... 10 - 7
10.3.1 System Configuration ......................................................................................................... 10 - 7
10.3.2 GOT Side Settings.............................................................................................................. 10 - 8
10.3.3 Install and setting the required software ............................................................................. 10 - 8
10.3.4 Precautions......................................................................................................................... 10 - 8
A - 14
14.4.3 Installing and setting multimedia interaction tool onto personal computer ......................... 14 - 6
14.4.4 Setting the multimedia function .......................................................................................... 14 - 6
14.4.5 Set the gateway function .................................................................................................... 14 - 6
14.5 Precautions.................................................................................................................................... 14 - 7
INDEX
REVISIONS
WARRANTY
A - 15
MANUALS
SH-080866ENG
GT Designer3 Version1 Screen Design Manual (Fundamentals) 1/2, 2/2 Stored in CD-ROM
(1D7MB9)
SH-080867ENG
GT Designer3 Version1 Screen Design Manual (Functions) 1/2, 2/2 Stored in CD-ROM
(1D7MC1)
SH-080861ENG
GT Simulator3 Version1 Operating Manual for GT Works3 Stored in CD-ROM
(1D7MB1)
SH-080862ENG
GT Converter2 Version3 Operating Manual for GT Works3 Stored in CD-ROM
(1D7MB2)
Connection manuals
Manual Number
Manual Name Packaging
(Model code)
SH-080868ENG
GOT1000 Series Connection Manual (Mitsubishi Electric Products) for GT Works3 Stored in CD-ROM
(1D7MC2)
SH-080869ENG
GOT1000 Series Connection Manual (Non-Mitsubishi Electric Products 1) for GT Works3 Stored in CD-ROM
(1D7MC3)
SH-080870ENG
GOT1000 Series Connection Manual (Non-Mitsubishi Electric Products 2) for GT Works3 Stored in CD-ROM
(1D7MC4)
GOT1000 Series Connection Manual (Microcomputer, MODBUS Products, Peripherals) for GT SH-080871ENG
Stored in CD-ROM
Works3 (1D7MC5)
SH-080858ENG
GOT1000 Series Gateway Functions Manual for GT Works3 Stored in CD-ROM
(1D7MA7)
SH-080859ENG
GOT1000 Series MES Interface Function Manual for GT Works3 Stored in CD-ROM
(1D7MA8)
SH-080863ENG
GOT1000 Series User's Manual (Extended Functions, Option Functions) for GT Works3 Stored in CD-ROM
(1D7MB3)
GT SoftGOT1000 manuals
Manual Number
Manual Name Packaging
(Model code)
SH-080860ENG
GT SoftGOT1000 Version3 Operating Manual for GT Works3 Stored in CD-ROM
(1D7MA9)
A - 16
GT16 manuals
Manual Number
Manual Name Packaging
(Model code)
SH-080928ENG
GT16 User's Manual (Hardware) Stored in CD-ROM
(1D7MD3)
SH-080929ENG
GT16 User's Manual (Basic Utility) Stored in CD-ROM
(1D7MD4)
JY997D41201
GT16 Handy GOT User's Manual Stored in CD-ROM JY997D41202
(09R821)
GT15 manuals
Manual Number
Manual Name Packaging
(Model code)
SH-080528ENG
GT15 User's Manual Stored in CD-ROM
(1D7M23)
GT14 manuals
Manual Number
Manual Name Packaging
(Model code)
JY997D44801
GT14 User's Manual Stored in CD-ROM
(09R823)
GT12 manuals
Manual Number
Manual Name Packaging
(Model code)
SH-080977ENG
GT12 User's Manual Stored in CD-ROM
(1D7ME1)
GT11 manuals
Manual Number
Manual Name Packaging
(Model code)
JY997D17501
GT11 User's Manual Stored in CD-ROM
(09R815)
JY997D20101
GT11 Handy GOT User's Manual Stored in CD-ROM JY997D20102
(09R817)
GT10 manuals
Manual Number
Manual Name Packaging
(Model code)
JY997D24701
GT10 User's Manual Stored in CD-ROM
(09R819)
A - 17
QUICK REFERENCE
Creating a project
Obtaining the specifications and operation methods of GT Designer3
Simulating a created project on a personal computer GT Simulator3 Version1 Operating Manual for GT Works3
Obtaining information of Non-Mitsubishi Electric products applicable to the • GOT1000 Series Connection Manual (Non-Mitsubishi
GOT Electric Products 1) for GT Works3
• GOT1000 Series Connection Manual (Non-Mitsubishi
Connecting Non-Mitsubishi Electric products to the GOT Electric Products 2) for GT Works3
A - 18
Others
Obtaining specifications (including part names, external dimensions, and • GT16 User's Manual (Hardware)
options) of each GOT • GT16 Handy GOT User's Manual
• GT15 User's Manual
• GT14 User's Manual
• GT12 User's Manual
Installing the GOT • GT11 User's Manual
• GT11 Handy GOT User's Manual
• GT10 User's Manual
Configuring the gateway function GOT1000 Series Gateway Functions Manual for GT Works3
Using a personal computer as the GOT GT SoftGOT1000 Version3 Operating Manual for GT Works3
A - 19
ABBREVIATIONS AND GENERIC TERMS
GOT
Abbreviations and generic terms Description
GT1695 GT1695M-X Abbreviation of GT1695M-XTBA, GT1695M-XTBD
GT1685 GT1685M-S Abbreviation of GT1685M-STBA, GT1685M-STBD
GT1675M-S Abbreviation of GT1675M-STBA, GT1675M-STBD
GT1675 GT1675M-V Abbreviation of GT1675M-VTBA, GT1675M-VTBD
GT1675-VN Abbreviation of GT1675-VNBA, GT1675-VNBD
GT1672 GT1672-VN Abbreviation of GT1672-VNBA, GT1672-VNBD
GT1665M-S Abbreviation of GT1665M-STBA, GT1665M-STBD
GT1665
GT1665M-V Abbreviation of GT1665M-VTBA, GT1665M-VTBD
GT1662 GT1662-VN Abbreviation of GT1662-VNBA, GT1662-VNBD
GT16 Abbreviation of GT1695, GT1685, GT1675, GT1672, GT1665, GT1662, GT1655, GT16 Handy GOT
GT1595 GT1595-X Abbreviation of GT1595-XTBA, GT1595-XTBD
GT1585V-S Abbreviation of GT1585V-STBA, GT1585V-STBD
GT1585
GT1585-S Abbreviation of GT1585-STBA, GT1585-STBD
GT1575V-S Abbreviation of GT1575V-STBA, GT1575V-STBD
GT1575-S Abbreviation of GT1575-STBA, GT1575-STBD
GT157 GT1575-V Abbreviation of GT1575-VTBA, GT1575-VTBD
GT1575-VN Abbreviation of GT1575-VNBA, GT1575-VNBD
GT1572-VN Abbreviation of GT1572-VNBA, GT1572-VNBD
GT1565-V Abbreviation of GT1565-VTBA, GT1565-VTBD
GT156
GT1562-VN Abbreviation of GT1562-VNBA, GT1562-VNBD
GT1555-V Abbreviation of GT1555-VTBD
A - 20
Abbreviations and generic terms Description
GT16
Handy GT1665HS-V Abbreviation of GT1665HS-VTBD
Handy GOT
GOT1000
GOT GT11 GT1155HS-Q Abbreviation of GT1155HS-QSBD
Series
Handy
GOT GT1150HS-Q Abbreviation of GT1150HS-QLBD
Communication unit
Abbreviations and generic terms Description
GT15-QBUS, GT15-QBUS2, GT15-ABUS, GT15-ABUS2, GT15-75QBUSL, GT15-75QBUS2L,
Bus connection unit
GT15-75ABUSL, GT15-75ABUS2L
Serial communication unit GT15-RS2-9P, GT15-RS4-9S, GT15-RS4-TE
RS-422 conversion unit GT15-RS2T4-9P, GT15-RS2T4-25P
Ethernet communication unit GT15-J71E71-100
MELSECNET/H communication unit GT15-J71LP23-25, GT15-J71BR13
Option unit
Abbreviations and generic terms Description
Printer unit GT15-PRN
Video input unit GT16M-V4, GT15V-75V4
RGB input unit GT16M-R2, GT15V-75R1
Video/RGB unit
Video/RGB input unit GT16M-V4R1, GT15V-75V4R1
RGB output unit GT16M-ROUT, GT15V-75ROUT
Multimedia unit GT16M-MMR
CF card unit GT15-CFCD
*1 GT15-CFEX-C08SET
CF card extension unit
External I/O unit GT15-DIO, GT15-DIOR
Sound output unit GT15-SOUT
A - 21
Option
Abbreviations and generic terms Description
GT05-MEM-16MC, GT05-MEM-32MC, GT05-MEM-64MC, GT05-MEM-128MC,
CF card GT05-MEM-256MC, GT05-MEM-512MC, GT05-MEM-1GC, GT05-MEM-2GC,
Memory card GT05-MEM-4GC, GT05-MEM-8GC, GT05-MEM-16GC
SD card L1MEM-2GBSD, L1MEM-4GBSD
Memory card adaptor GT05-MEM-ADPC
GT16-MESB, GT15-FNB, GT15-QFNB, GT15-QFNB16M,
Option function board
GT15-QFNB32M, GT15-QFNB48M, GT11-50FNB, GT15-MESB48M
Battery GT15-BAT, GT11-50BAT
GT16-90PSCB, GT16-90PSGB, GT16-90PSCW, GT16-90PSGW,
GT16-80PSCB, GT16-80PSGB, GT16-80PSCW, GT16-80PSGW,
GT16-70PSCB, GT16-70PSGB, GT16-70PSCW, GT16-70PSGW,
For GT16 GT16-60PSCB, GT16-60PSGB, GT16-60PSCW, GT16-60PSGW,
GT16-50PSCB, GT16-50PSGB, GT16-50PSCW, GT16-50PSGW,
GT16-90PSCB-012, GT16-80PSCB-012, GT16-70PSCB-012,
GT16-60PSCB-012, GT16-50PSCB-012, GT16H-60PSC
GT15-90PSCB, GT15-90PSGB, GT15-90PSCW, GT15-90PSGW,
GT15-80PSCB, GT15-80PSGB, GT15-80PSCW, GT15-80PSGW,
For GT15 GT15-70PSCB, GT15-70PSGB, GT15-70PSCW, GT15-70PSGW,
Protective Sheet GT15-60PSCB, GT15-60PSGB, GT15-60PSCW, GT15-60PSGW,
GT15-50PSCB, GT15-50PSGB, GT15-50PSCW, GT15-50PSGW
For GT14 GT14-50PSCB, GT14-50PSGB, GT14-50PSCW, GT14-50PSGW
For GT12 GT11-70PSCB, GT11-65PSCB
GT11-50PSCB, GT11-50PSGB, GT11-50PSCW, GT11-50PSGW,
For GT11
GT11H-50PSC
GT10-50PSCB, GT10-50PSGB, GT10-50PSCW, GT10-50PSGW,
GT10-40PSCB, GT10-40PSGB, GT10-40PSCW, GT10-40PSGW,
For GT10
GT10-30PSCB, GT10-30PSGB, GT10-30PSCW, GT10-30PSGW,
GT10-20PSCB, GT10-20PSGB, GT10-20PSCW, GT10-20PSGW
GT05-90PCO, GT05-80PCO, GT05-70PCO, GT05-60PCO, GT05-50PCO,
Protective cover for oil
GT16-50PCO, GT10-40PCO, GT10-30PCO, GT10-20PCO
USB environmental protection cover GT16-UCOV, GT16-50UCOV, GT15-UCOV, GT14-50UCOV, GT11-50UCOV
Stand GT15-90STAND, GT15-80STAND, GT15-70STAND, A9GT-50STAND, GT05-50STAND
GT15-70ATT-98, GT15-70ATT-87, GT15-60ATT-97, GT15-60ATT-96,
Attachment
GT15-60ATT-87, GT15-60ATT-77, GT15-50ATT-95W, GT15-50ATT-85
GT16-90XLTT, GT16-80SLTT, GT16-70SLTT, GT16-70VLTT, GT16-70VLTTA, GT16-70VLTN,
Backlight GT16-60SLTT, GT16-60VLTT, GT16-60VLTN, GT15-90XLTT, GT15-80SLTT, GT15-70SLTT,
GT15-70VLTT, GT15-70VLTN, GT15-60VLTT, GT15-60VLTN
Multi-color display board GT15-XHNB, GT15-VHNB
Connector conversion box GT11H-CNB-37S, GT16H-CNB-42S
Emergency stop sw guard cover GT11H-50ESCOV, GT16H-60ESCOV
With wall-mounting Attachment GT14H-50ATT
Memory loader GT10-LDR
Memory board GT10-50FMB
Panel-mounted USB port extension GT14-C10EXUSB-4S, GT10-C10EXUSB-5S
A - 22
Software
Abbreviations and generic terms Description
GT Works3 Abbreviation of the SW DNC-GTWK3-E and SW DNC-GTWK3-EA
GT Designer3 Abbreviation of screen drawing software GT Designer3 for GOT1000 series
GT Simulator3 Abbreviation of screen simulator GT Simulator3 for GOT1000/GOT900 series
GT SoftGOT1000 Abbreviation of monitoring software GT SoftGOT1000
GT Converter2 Abbreviation of data conversion software GT Converter2 for GOT1000/GOT900 series
GT Designer2 Classic Abbreviation of screen drawing software GT Designer2 Classic for GOT900 series
GT Designer2 Abbreviation of screen drawing software GT Designer2 for GOT1000/GOT900 series
iQ Works Abbreviation of iQ Platform compatible engineering environment MELSOFT iQ Works
Generic term for integrated development environment software included in the SW DNC-IQWK (iQ
MELSOFT Navigator
Platform compatible engineering environment MELSOFT iQ Works)
Abbreviation of SW DNC-GXW2-E and SW DNC-GXW2-EA type programmable controller
GX Works2
engineering software
GX Simulator2 Abbreviation of GX Works2 with the simulation function
Abbreviation of SW D5C-LLT-E(-EV) type ladder logic test tool function software packages
GX Simulator
(SW5D5C-LLT (-EV) or later versions)
GX Developer Abbreviation of SW D5C-GPPW-E(-EV)/SW D5F-GPPW-E type software package
GX LogViewer Abbreviation of SW DNN-VIEWER-E type software package
PX Developer Abbreviation of SW D5C-FBDQ-E type FBD software package for process control
Abbreviation of motion controller engineering environment MELSOFT MT Works2
MT Works2
(SW DNC-MTW2-E)
MT Developer Abbreviation of SW RNC-GSV type integrated start-up support software for motion controller Q series
MR Configurator2 Abbreviation of SW DNC-MRC2-E type Servo Configuration Software
MR Configurator Abbreviation of MRZJW -SETUP E type Servo Configuration Software
FR Configurator Abbreviation of Inverter Setup Software (FR-SW -SETUP-WE)
NC Configurator Abbreviation of CNC parameter setting support tool NC Configurator
Abbreviation of parameter setting, monitoring, and testing software packages for FX3U-20SSC-H
FX Configurator-FP
(SW D5C-FXSSC-E)
FX3U-ENET-L Configuration tool Abbreviation of FX3U-ENET-L type Ethernet module setting software (SW1D5-FXENETL-E)
RT ToolBox2 Abbreviation of robot program creation software (3D-11C-WINE)
MX Component Abbreviation of MX Component Version (SW D5C-ACT-E, SW D5C-ACT-EA)
MX Sheet Abbreviation of MX Sheet Version (SW D5C-SHEET-E, SW D5C-SHEET-EA)
QnUDVCPU & LCPU Logging Configuration
Abbreviation of QnUDVCPU & LCPU Logging Configuration Tool (SW1DNN-LLUTL-E)
Tool
A - 23
Others
Abbreviations and generic terms Description
IAI Abbreviation of IAI Corporation
AZBIL Abbreviation of Azbil Corporation (former Yamatake Corporation)
OMRON Abbreviation of OMRON Corporation
KEYENCE Abbreviation of KEYENCE CORPORATION
KOYO EI Abbreviation of KOYO ELECTRONICS INDUSTRIES CO., LTD.
SHARP Abbreviation of Sharp Manufacturing Systems Corporation
JTEKT Abbreviation of JTEKT Corporation
SHINKO Abbreviation of Shinko Technos Co., Ltd.
CHINO Abbreviation of CHINO CORPORATION
TOSHIBA Abbreviation of TOSHIBA CORPORATION
TOSHIBA MACHINE Abbreviation of TOSHIBA MACHINE CO., LTD.
HITACHI IES Abbreviation of Hitachi Industrial Equipment Systems Co., Ltd.
HITACHI Abbreviation of Hitachi, Ltd.
FUJI Abbreviation of FUJI ELECTRIC CO., LTD.
PANASONIC Abbreviation of Panasonic Corporation
PANASONIC INDUSTRIAL DEVICES SUNX Abbreviation of Panasonic Industrial Devices SUNX Co., Ltd.
YASKAWA Abbreviation of YASKAWA Electric Corporation
YOKOGAWA Abbreviation of Yokogawa Electric Corporation
ALLEN-BRADLEY Abbreviation of Allen-Bradley products manufactured by Rockwell Automation, Inc.
GE Abbreviation of GE Intelligent Platforms
LS IS Abbreviation of LS Industrial Systems Co., Ltd.
SCHNEIDER Abbreviation of Schneider Electric SA
SICK Abbreviation of SICK AG
SIEMENS Abbreviation of Siemens AG
RKC Abbreviation of RKC INSTRUMENT INC.
HIRATA Abbreviation of Hirata Corporation
MURATEC Abbreviation of Muratec products manufactured by Muratec Automation Co., Ltd.
PLC Abbreviation of programmable controller
Temperature controller Generic term for temperature controller manufactured by each corporation
Indicating controller Generic term for indicating controller manufactured by each corporation
Control equipment Generic term for control equipment manufactured by each corporation
CHINO controller Abbreviation of indicating controller manufactured by CHINO CORPORATION
PC CPU module Abbreviation of PC CPU Unit manufactured by CONTEC CO., LTD
GOT (server) Abbreviation of GOTs that use the server function
GOT (client) Abbreviation of GOTs that use the client function
Generic term for the protocol designed to use MODBUS protocol messages on a serial
MODBUS/RTU
communication
MODBUS/TCP Generic term for the protocol designed to use MODBUS protocol messages on a TCP/IP network
A - 24
HOW TO READ THIS MANUAL
Symbols
Following symbols are used in this manual.
Shows GT16.
Shows GT15.
Shows GT14.
Shows GT12.
Shows GT11.
Shows GT10.
1. 2. 3. …
Indicates the operation steps.
2.
[ ]: Indicates the setting items displayed on
the software and GOT screen.
3.
4.
Refers to the information required.
Since the above page was created for explanation purpose, it differs from the actual page.
A - 25
About system configuration
The following describes the system configuration of each connection included in this manual.
RS-422 connector
QCPU GOT
conversion Cable
A representative example
Connection cable of the system configuration
is described with an
illustration.
(When connecting the PLC [MELSEC-Q] and GT16, with RS-422 cable)
1) Connect the RS-422 conversion cable [FA-CNV2402CBL] to the [MELSEC-Q].
Indicates the commercially available 2) Connect the option [GT16-C02R4-9S] to [GT16].
cable models that can be used. 3) Connect [MELSEQ-Q] and [GT16] with the connection cable [GT01-C30R4-25P].
Since the above page was created for explanation purpose, it differs from the actual page.
A - 26
1
1
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
2
MICROCOMPUTER
PREPARATORY PROCEDURES
CONNECTION
(SERIAL)
1.
FOR MONITORING 3
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
1.1 Setting the Communication Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 - 3
1.2 Writing the Project Data and OS onto the GOT . . . . . . . . . 1 - 13
1.3 Option Devices for the Respective Connection . . . . . . . . . 1 - 15 4
1.4 Connection Cables for the Respective Connection . . . . . . 1 - 24
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
1.5 Verifying GOT Recognizes Connected Equipment . . . . . . 1 - 32
1.6 Checking for Normal Monitoring. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1 - 36
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
6
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
1-1
1. PREPARATORY PROCEDURES FOR
MONITORING
The following shows the procedures to be taken before monitoring and corresponding reference sections.
Attaching the communication unit and 1.3 Option Devices for the Respective Connection
connecting the cable 1.4 Connection Cables for the Respective Connection
Each chapter System Configuration
Mount the optional equipment and prepare/connect the
Each chapter Connection Diagram
connection cable according to the connection type.
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
Set the communication interface of GOT and the connected equipment.
When using the GOT at the first time, make sure to set the channel of communication interface and the communication
driver before writing to GOT.
Set the communication interface of the GOT at [Controller Setting] and [I/F Communication Setting] in GT Designer3.
MICROCOMPUTER
Set the channel of the equipment connected to the GOT.
CONNECTION
Setting
(SERIAL)
3
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
4
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
5
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
1. Select [Common] [Controller Setting] from the menu.
2. The Controller Setting dialog box appears. Select the channel No. to be used from the list menu.
6
3. Refer to the following explanations for the setting.
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
POINT UNIT
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
Item Description
Use CH* Select this item when setting the channel No.2 to No.4.
Select the type of the equipment to be connected to the GOT. For the settings, refer to the following.
Type
(2)Setting [Controller Type]
Select the interface of the GOT to which the equipment is connected.For the settings, refer to the following.
I/F
(3)Setting [I/F]
Select the communication driver to be written to the GOT.For the settings, refer to the following.
Driver
(1)Setting [Driver]
Make settings for the transmission speed and data length of the communication driver.
Detail Setting
Refer to each chapter of the equipment to be connected to the GOT.
PROCEDURES FOR
The types for the selection differs depending on the PLC to be used.
For the settings, refer to the following.
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
Type Model name Manufacturer
NFCP100
YOKOGAWA
NFJT100
MICROCOMPUTER
TSX P57 253M
CONNECTION
TSX P57 353M
(SERIAL)
TSX P57 453M
MICROCOMPUTER
140 CPU 651 50
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
140 CPU 651 60
MODBUS(R)/RTU
Microcomputer connection Microcomputer -
CONNECTION
5
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
6
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
(a) GT16
Extension interface 1
Standard interface 3
2nd stage (RS-422/485 interface built in the GOT)
Standard interface 4
(Ethernet interface built in the GOT)
1st stage
Standard interface 1
(RS-232 interface built in the GOT)
(b) GT15
Extension interface 1
Extension interface 2
3rd stage
2nd stage
1st stage
Standard interface 1
(RS-232 interface built in the GOT)
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
2
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(SERIAL)
[Front view]] [Rear view]
Standard interface 3 Standard interface 1 3
(GOT built-in USB interface) (GOT built-in RS-422 interface)
MICROCOMPUTER
Standard interface 2
CONNECTION
(GOT built-in RS-232 interface)
(ETHERNET)
4
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
Standard interface 4
(GOT built-in Ethernet interface)
[Under view]
5
(d) GT12
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
6
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
Standard interface 2
(GOT built-in RS-232 interface)
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
Standard interface 2
(GOT built-in RS-232 interface)
• GT11 Bus
Standard interface 1
(GOT built-in Bus interface)
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
2
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(SERIAL)
[Rear view]
3
Standard interface 1 Standard interface 3
MICROCOMPUTER
(GOT built-in RS-422 interface) (GOT built-in USB interface)
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
Standard interface 2
(GOT built-in RS-232 interface)
(g) GT104
4
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
5
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
Standard interface 1 Standard interface 3
(GOT built-in RS-422 interface) (GOT built-in USB interface)
Standard interface 2
6
(GOT built-in RS-232 interface)
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
(h) GT1020, GT1030 UNIT
Standard interface 1
(GOT built-in RS-422 interface)
7
Standard interface 2
or (GOT built-in RS-232 interface) (GOT built-in RS-232 interface)
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
Setting
2. The I/F Communication Setting dialog box appears. Make the settings with reference to the following explanation.
PROCEDURES FOR
The following describes the setting items for the standard I/F setting and extension I/F setting.
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
2
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(SERIAL)
3
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
4
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
Item Description
Set channel No. and drivers to the GOT standard interfaces.
GT16, GT14, GT12: Standard I/F-1, Standard I/F-2, Standard I/F-3, Standard I/F-4 5
Standard I/F Setting
GT15, GT1030, GT1020: Standard I/F-1, Standard I/F-2
GT11, GT105 , GT104 : Standard I/F-1, Standard I/F-2, Standard I/F-3
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
Set the CH No. according to the intended purpose.
The number of channels differs depending on the GOT to be used.
0: Not used
1 to 4: Used for connecting a controller of channel No. 1 to 4 set in Setting connected equipment (Channel
setting)
CH No.
8: Used for barcode reader connection, RFID connection, PC remote operation connection (serial) fingerprint
authentication device connection, or printer (serial) GOT (extended computer)
6
9: Used for connecting Host (PC) or Host (modem)
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
*: Used for gateway function, MES interface function, and Ethernet download
Multi: Used for Ethernet multiple connection
I/F The communication type of the GOT standard interface is displayed.
Set the driver for the device to be connected.
UNIT
Driver
None Host (PC) Each communication driver for connected devices
Detail Setting
Make settings for the transmission speed and data length of the communication driver.
Refer to each chapter of the equipment to be connected to the GOT.
7
To validate the 5V power supply function in RS232, mark the [Enable the 5V power supply] checkbox.
CONNECTION TO
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
POINT
Channel No., drivers, [RS232 Setting]
(1) Channel No.2 to No.4
Use the channel No.2 to No.4 when using the Multi-channel function.
For details of the Multi-channel function, refer to the following.
Mitsubishi Electric Products 20. MULTI-CHANNEL FUNCTION
(2) Drivers
The displayed items for a driver differ according to the settings [Manufacturer], [Controller Type] and [I/F].
When the driver to be set is not displayed, confirm if [Manufacturer], [Controller Type] and [I/F] are correct.
[Setting the communication] section in each chapter
(3) [RS232 Setting] of GT14
Do not use [RS232 Setting] of GT14 for other than the 5V power feeding to the RS-232/485 signal conversion
adaptor.
For details, refer to the following manual.
GT14 User's Manual 7.11 RS-232/485 Signal Conversion Adaptor
1.1.3 Precautions
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
Write the standard monitor OS, communication driver, option OS, project data and communication settings onto the GOT.
For details on writing to GOT, refer to the following manual.
GT Designer3 Version1 Screen Design Manual
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(SERIAL)
3
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
4
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
5
1. Select [Communication] [Write to GOT…] from the menu.
MODBUS(R)/TCP
2. The [Communication configuration] dialog box appears.
CONNECTION
Set the communication setting between the GOT and the personal computer.
Click the [OK] button when settings are completed.
3. The [GOT Write] tab appears on the [Communicate with GOT] dialog box.
Select the [Project data, OS] radio button of the Write Data.
6
4. Check-mark a desired standard monitor OS, communication driver, option OS, extended function OS, and
Communication Settings and click the [GOT Write] button.
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
POINT UNIT
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
Confirm if the standard monitor OS, communication driver, option OS, project data and communication settings are
properly written onto the GOT by reading from GOT using GT Designer3.
For reading from the GOT, refer to the following manual.
GT Designer3 Version1 Screen Design Manual
3. The [GOT Read] tab appears on the [Communicate with GOT] dialog box.
Select the [Drive information] radio button of the Read Data.
5. Confirm that the project data and OS are written correctly onto the GOT.
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
The following shows the option devices to connect in the respective connection type.
For the specifications, usage and connecting procedure on option devices, refer to the respective device manual.
MICROCOMPUTER
For QCPU (Q mode), motion controller CPU (Q series)
GT15-QBUS
CONNECTION
Bus connection (1ch) unit standard model
(SERIAL)
For QCPU (Q mode), motion controller CPU (Q series)
GT15-QBUS2
Bus connection (2ch) unit standard model
MICROCOMPUTER
Bus connection (2ch) unit standard model
Bus connection unit
CONNECTION
For QCPU (Q mode), motion controller CPU (Q series)
(ETHERNET)
GT15-75QBUSL
Bus connection (1ch) unit slim model
GT15-75ABUSL
For A/QnACPU, motion controller CPU (A series)
Bus connection (1ch) unit slim model
4
For A/QnACPU, motion controller CPU (A series)
MODBUS(R)/RTU
GT15-75ABUS2L
Bus connection (1ch) unit slim model
CONNECTION
GT15-RS2-9P RS-232 serial communication unit (D-sub 9-pin (male))
Serial communication unit GT15-RS4-9S RS-422/485 serial communication unit (D-sub 9-pin (female))
MODBUS(R)/TCP
MELSECNET/H GT15-J71LP23-25 Optical loop unit
CONNECTION
Communication module GT15-J71BR13 Coaxial bus unit
CC-Link IE controller
GT15-J71GP23-SX Optical loop unit
6
network communication unit
CONNECTION TO
GT15-J61BT13 Intelligent device station unit CC-LINK Ver. 2 compatible
SOUND OUTPUT
CC-Link communication unit Intelligent device station unit
GT15-75J61BT13-Z
(A8GT-61BT13 + GT15-75IF900 set)
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
Multimedia unit GT16M-MMR For video input signal (NTSC/PAL) 1 ch, playing movie
GT16M-V4
Video input unit For video input signal (NTSC/PAL) 4 ch
GT15V-75V4
GT16M-R2
RGB input unit For analog RGB input signal 2 ch
GT15V-75R1
GT16M-V4R1
Video/RGB input unit For video input signal (NTSC/PAL) 4 ch, for analog RGB mixed input signal 1 ch
GT15V-75V4R1
GT16M-ROUT
RGB output unit For analog RGB output signal 1 ch
GT15V-75ROUT
CF card unit GT15-CFCD For CF card installation (B drive) For GOT back face CF card eject
CF card extension unit GT15-CFEX-C08SET For CF card installation (B drive) For control panel front face CF card eject
For the connection to external I/O device or operation panel (Negative Common
GT15-DIOR
Input/Source Type Output)
External I/O unit
For the connection to external I/O device or operation panel (Positive Common
GT15-DIO
Input/Sink Type Output)
FA-LTBGTR4CBL05
RS-485 terminal block RS-422/485 (Connector) RS-485 (Terminal block)
FA-LTBGTR4CBL10
conversion modules Supplied connection cable dedicated for the conversion unit
FA-LTBGTR4CBL20
Connector conversion adapter GT10-9PT5S RS-422/485 (D-Sub 9-pin connector) RS-422/485 (Terminal block)
RS-232/485 signal
GT14-RS2 4-9P RS-232 signal (D-Sub 9-pin connector) RS-485 signal (Terminal block)
conversion adapter
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
This section describes the precautions for installing units on another unit.
MONITORING
For the installation method of each unit, refer to the following manual.
GT16 User’s Manual (Hardware)
GT15 User's Manual
MICROCOMPUTER
For using multiple extension units, a bar code reader, or a RFID controller, the total current for the extension units,
bar code reader, or RFID controller must be within the current that the GOT can supply.
CONNECTION
For the current that the GOT can supply and the current for the extension units, bar code reader, or RFID controller,
(SERIAL)
refer to the following tables. Make sure that the total of consumed current is within the capacity of the GOT.
(1) Current supply capacity of the GOT
MICROCOMPUTER
(A) (A)
CONNECTION
GT1695M-X 2.4 GT1595-X 2.13
(ETHERNET)
GT1685M-S 2.4 GT1585V-S 1.74
GT1675M-V
GT1675-VN, GT1672-VN
2.4
2.4
GT1575V-S
GT1575-S
2.2
2.2
4
GT1665M-S 2.4 GT1575-V, GT1572-VN 2.2
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
GT1665M-V 2.4 GT1565-V, GT1562-VN 2.2
MODBUS(R)/TCP
Module type current Module type current
CONNECTION
(A) (A)
GT15-QBUS, GT15-QBUS2,
0.275*1 GT16M-R2 0*1
GT15-75QBUSL, GT15-75QBUS2L
GT15-ABUS, GT15-ABUS2,
GT15-75ABUSL, GT15-75ABUS2L
0.12 GT15V-75R1 0.2*1
6
GT15-RS2-9P 0.29 GT16M-V4R1 *1
0.12
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
GT15-RS4-9S 0.33 GT15V-75V4R1 0.2*1
GT15V-75V4 0.2*1
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
*1 Value used for calculating the current consumption of the multi-channel function.
For the specifications of the unit, refer to the manual included with the unit.
*2 When the GOT supplies power to a barcode reader or a RFID controller from the standard interface, add their consumed
current.(Maximum value is less than 0.3 A.)
2.2 0.77+0.33+0.33+0.33+0.224+0.12=2.104
Since the calculated value is within the capacity of the GOT, they can be connected to the GOT.
(b) When connecting the GT15-J71BR13, GT15-RS4-9S (2 units), GT15-J71E71-100 (for the gateway
function) and a bar code reader (0.12 A) to the GT1585-S
1.74 0.77+0.33+0.33+0.224+0.12=1.774
Since the calculated value exceeds the capacity of the GOT, such configuration is not allowed.
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
Cautions for using GT15-QBUS2 and GT15-ABUS2
The stage number of communication units installed on the next stage of GT15-QBUS2 or GT15-ABUS2 are
recognized by the GOT differently depending on the extension interface position.
For communication units installed in the extension interface 2 side, even if the communication unit is physically
installed in the 2nd stage position, the GOT recognizes the position as the 1st stage. 2
MICROCOMPUTER
Recognized as the
3rd stage of extend Recognized as the 2nd stage
CONNECTION
interface 1 of extend interface 2
(SERIAL)
Recognized as the
2nd stage of extend Recognized as the 1st stage
interface 1 of extend interface 2
3
Recognized as the 1st stage
MICROCOMPUTER
of extend interface 1
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
GT15-QBUS2, GT15-ABUS2
Relay connector
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
(2) Standard size bus connection unit (GT15-QBUS and GT15-ABUS)
A bus connection unit can be installed in any position (1st to 3rd stage) of the extension interface. 5
Example: Installing a bus connection unit and serial communication units
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
Serial communication unit Bus connection unit
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
Example: When installing a MELSECNET/H communication unit and a serial communication unit
POINT
Precautions for using a MELSECNET/H communication unit, CC-Link IE controller network communication unit,
CC-Link communication unit (GT15-J61BT13)
The installed stage number of communication units installed on the next stage of MELSECNET/H communication
unit, CC-Link IE controller network communication unit, or CC-Link communication unit are recognized by the GOT
differently depending on the extension interface position.
For communication units installed in the extension interface 2 side, even if the communication unit is physically
installed in the 2nd stage position, the GOT recognizes the position as the 1st stage.
Relay connector
PROCEDURES FOR
Z) or CC-Link communication unit (GT15-75J61BT13-Z)
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
Install a MELSECNET/10 communication unit (GT15-75J71LP23-Z, GT15-75J71BR13-Z) or CC-Link communication
unit (GT15-75J61BT13-Z) at the 1st stage of the extension interface.
These communication units cannot be used if installed in the 2nd or higher stage.
For GT16 and the GT155 , the MELSECNET/10 communication unit (GT15-75J71LP23-Z, GT15- 75J71BR13-Z)
and the CC-Link communication unit (GT15-75J61BT13-Z) are not applicable. 2
Example: When installing a MELSECNET/10 communication unit and a serial communication unit
MICROCOMPUTER
MELSECNET/10
CONNECTION
communication unit
(SERIAL)
Serial communication unit
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
When using an Ethernet communication unit 4
An Ethernet communication unit can be installed in any position (1st to 3rd stage) of the extension interface.
For GT16, the Ethernet communication unit is not applicable.
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
Use the Ethernet interface built in the GOT.
Example: When installing an Ethernet communication unit and a serial communication unit
MODBUS(R)/TCP
communication unit
CONNECTION
6
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
When using a serial communication unit
A serial communication unit can be installed in any position (1st to 3rd stage) of the extension interface. UNIT
Serial Serial
communication communication
unit unit 7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
When using the video input unit, RGB input unit, video/RGB input unit, RGB output unit, or
multimedia unit
Install the video input unit, RGB input unit, video/RGB input unit, RGB output unit, or multimedia unit at the 1st stage
of the extension interface.If any of these units is installed in the 2nd stage or above, the unit cannot be used.
When any of these units is used, the communication units indicated below must be installed in the 2nd stage of the
extension interface.
Communication unit Model
MELSECNET/H communication
GT15-J71LP23-25, GT15-J71BR13
unit
CC-Link IE controller
GT15-J71GP23-SX
network communication unit
Example: When installing a video input unit and a MELSECNET/H communication unit
MELSECNET/H Video/RGB
communication unit
input unit
Video/RGB MELSECNET/H
communication unit
input unit
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
Precautions for video input unit, RGB input unit, video/RGB input unit, RGB output unit, and multimedia unit
When a communication unit is installed on any of the units above, the stage number of the communication unit
recognized by the GOT varies according to the extension interface.
For communication units installed in the extension interface 2 side, even if the communication unit is physically
installed in the 2nd stage position, the GOT recognizes the position as the 1st stage. 2
MICROCOMPUTER
Recognized as the 3rd stage of
extension interface 1 Recognized as the 2nd stage
CONNECTION
of extension interface 2
(SERIAL)
Recognized as the 2nd stage of
extension interface 1 Recognized as the 1st stage
of extension interface 2
3
MICROCOMPUTER
Recognized as the 1st stage of
extension interface 1
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
Video/RGB input unit
Relay connector
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
When using CF card unit or CF card extension unit
Install the CF card unit or CF card extension unit on the extension interface at the last. 5
The following figures show how to install the CF card unit.
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CF card unit
CONNECTION
Serial communication
unit
Serial communication
unit
CF card unit
6
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
RS-232 interface
Use the following as the RS-232 interface and RS-232 communication unit connector on the GOT. For the GOT side
connection cable, use a connector and connector cover applicable to the GOT connector.
(1) Connector specifications
Hardware
GOT Connector type Connector model Manufacturer
version*1
GT16 ― 17LE-23090-27(D4C )
GT1595-X ― DDK Ltd.
17LE-23090-27(D4CK)
GT1585V-S ―
B or later GM-C9RMDU11 Honda Tsushin Kogyo Co., Ltd.
GT1585-STBA
C
GT1585-STBD ― 17LE-23090-27(D4CK) DDK Ltd.
GT1575V-S ―
B or later GM-C9RMDU11 Honda Tsushin Kogyo Co., Ltd.
GT1575-STBA
C
17LE-23090-27(D4CK) DDK Ltd.
GT1575-STBD ―
D or later GM-C9RMDU11 Honda Tsushin Kogyo Co., Ltd.
GT1575-VTBA 9-pin D-sub (male)
E
inch screw fixed type
GT1575-VTBD ―
GT1575-VN ―
GT1572-VN ―
17LE-23090-27(D4CK)
GT1565-V ―
GT1562-VN ―
DDK Ltd.
GT12 ―
GT155 ―
GT14 ―
GT115 -Q ―
17LE-23090-27(D3CC)
GT105 -Q ―
GT104 -Q ―
*1 For the procedure to check the GT15 hardware version, refer to the GT15 User's Manual.
*2 The terminal block (MC1.5/9-ST-3.5 or corresponding product) of the cable side is packed together with the GT1030 and
GT1020.
6 9
9-pin D-sub (male) 9-pin terminal block
PROCEDURES FOR
Use the following as the RS-422 interface and RS-422/485 communication unit connector on the GOT.
PREPARATORY
For the GOT side of the connection cable, use a connector and connector cover applicable to the GOT connector.
MONITORING
(1) Connector model
GOT Connector type Connector model Manufacturer
MICROCOMPUTER
GT16*1 14-pin (female) HDR-EC14LFDT1-SLE+ Honda Tsushin Kogyo Co., Ltd.
CONNECTION
GT14
(SERIAL)
GT12
9-pin D-sub (female)
GT115 -Q M2.6 millimeter screw 17LE-13090-27(D3AC) DDK Ltd.
GT105 -Q
fixed type 3
MICROCOMPUTER
GT104 -Q
CONNECTION
GT1030, GT1020 9-pin terminal block*2 MC1.5/9-G-3.5BK PHOENIX CONTACT Inc.
(ETHERNET)
GT15-RS4-9S 9-pin D-sub (female)
M2.6 millimeter screw 17LE-13090-27(D3AC) DDK Ltd.
GT01-RS4-M fixed type
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
(2) Connector pin arrangement
GT15, GT14, GT12, GT11, GT105 ,
GT16 GT1030, GT1020
GT104 , GT01-RS4-M
GOT main part connector GOT main part connector See from the back of a 5
see from the front see from the front GOT main part
MODBUS(R)/TCP
8 14 5 1
CONNECTION
1 7
CSB
CSA
RSB
RSA
RDB
RDA
SDB
SDA
SG
9 6
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
GT14 ―
GT12 ―
GT1155-QTBD C or later
9-pin D-sub (female)
GT1155-QSBD M2.6 millimeter screw 17LE-13090-27(D3AC) DDK Ltd.
F or later
fixed type
GT1150-QLBD
GT105 -Q C or later
GT104 -Q A or later
GT1030 B or later
9-pin terminal block*3 MC1.5/9-G-3.5BK PHOENIX CONTACT Inc
GT1020 E or later
*1 For the checking procedure of the hardware version, refer to the User's Manual.
*2 When connecting to the RS-422/485 interface, use HDR-E14MAG1+ as a cable connector.
To use HDR-E14MAG1+, a dedicated pressure welding tool is required.
For details on the connector and pressure welding tool, contact Honda Tsushin Kogyo Co., Ltd..
*3 The terminal block (MC1.5/9-ST-3.5 or corresponding product) of the cable side is packed together with the GT1030, GT1020.
GOT main part connector GOT main part connector See from the back of a
see from the front see from the front GOT main part
5 1
8 14
1 7
CSB
CSA
RSB
RSA
RDB
RDA
SDB
SDA
9 6
SG
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
The following describes the method for connecting the BNC connector (connector plug for coaxial cable) and the cable.
MONITORING
CAUTION
Solder the coaxial cable connectors properly.
Insufficient soldering may result in malfunctions. 2
MICROCOMPUTER
Components of the BNC connector Structure of the coaxial cable
CONNECTION
External conductor
(SERIAL)
Outer sheath Insulating material
Nut Washer Gasket
Plug shell
3
MICROCOMPUTER
Internal conductor
Clamp Contact
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
1. Remove the external sheath of the coaxial cable with
dimensions as shown below.
A
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
2. Pass the nut, washer, gasket, and clamp through the coaxial
Clamp
cable as shown on the left and loosen the external conductor.
Nut 5
Washer
Gasket
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
Insulating material 3. Cut the external conductor, insulting material, and internal
Internal conductor conductor with the dimensions as shown below.
Note that the external conductor should be cut to the same
dimension as the tapered section of the clamp and smoothed
C
B Clamp and external
down to the clamp. 6
conductor Cable in use B C
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
3C-2V 6mm 3mm
4.
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
8
Precautions for soldering
DEVICE CONNECTION
Note the following precautions when soldering the internal conductor and contact.
AUTHENTICATION
• Make sure that the solder does not bead up at the soldered section.
FINGERPRINT
• Make sure there are no gaps between the connector and cable insulator or they do not cut into each other.
• Perform soldering quickly so the insulation material does not become deformed.
The following shows the terminating resistor specifications on the GOT side.
When setting the terminating resistor in each connection type, refer to the following.
ON
ON
resistor*1 1 2 SW1 resistor*1 1 2 SW1
1
1
100 OHM ON ON 100 OHM ON ON
2
2
Disable OFF OFF Disable OFF OFF
SW1
1
2
ON
GT14
Set the terminating resistor using the terminating
resistor setting switch.
PROCEDURES FOR
Set the terminating resistor using the terminating Set the terminating resistor using the terminating
PREPARATORY
resistor setting switch. resistor setting switch.
MONITORING
2
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(SERIAL)
3
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
Terminating resistor selector switch
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
resistor setting switch.
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
6
CONNECTION TO
Terminating resistor selector switch SOUND OUTPUT
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
Set the 2-wire/4-wire terminating resistor setting switch according to the connection type.
MONITORING
POINT
Enable the 5V power supply
Make sure to validate "Enable the 5V power supply" in the [RS232 Setting] to operate the RS-232/485 signal 2
conversion adaptor.
MICROCOMPUTER
1.2.2 Checking the project data and OS writing on GOT
CONNECTION
When validating the function using the utility function of the GOT main unit, refer to the following manual.
(SERIAL)
GT14 User's Manual 8.2 Utility Function List
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
2-wire/4-wire terminating resistor setting switch
4
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
Setting the 2-wire/4-wire terminating resistor setting switch
5
O
N
MODBUS(R)/TCP
1
2
3
4
5
6
CONNECTION
Switch No.
Setting item Set value
1 2 3 4 5 6
2-wire/4-wire
2-wire (1Pair) ON ON - - - OFF 6
4-wire (2Pair) OFF OFF - - - OFF
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
110 - - ON OFF OFF OFF
POINT 7
CONNECTION TO
For details on the RS-232/485 signal conversion adapter, refer to the following manual.
GT14-RS2T4-9P RS-232/485 Signal Conversion Adapter User's Manual
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
2.
PROCEDURES FOR
4. Verify that the communication driver name to
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
be used is displayed in the communication
interface box to be used.
MICROCOMPUTER
1.1Setting the Communication Interface
CONNECTION
(SERIAL)
3
MICROCOMPUTER
For GT15, GT14 or GT11
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
1. After powering up the GOT, touch [Main menu]
[Communication setting] from the Utility.
1. 4
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
5
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
2. Touch [Communication setting].
(The screen on the left is not displayed on 6
GT11.)
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
2. UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
For GT10
1. 1. After powering up the GOT, touch [Main menu]
[Communication setting] from the Utility.
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
Utility
(1) How to display Utility (at default)
When using GT16, GT1595, GT14, GT12 or GT1020
2
Utility call key
1-point press on GOT screen upper-left corner
Utility display
(When using GT16,GT12) (When using GT15)
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(SERIAL)
3
(When using GT105 ,
MICROCOMPUTER
When using GT1585, GT157 , (When using GT14, GT11) GT104 )
CONNECTION
GT156 , GT155 , GT11, GT105 ,
(ETHERNET)
GT104 or GT1030
Utility call key
Simultaneous 2-point press
4
(When using GT1030,GT1020)
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
(2) Utility call
When setting [Pressing time] to other than 0 second on the setting screen of the utility call key, press and hold 5
the utility call key until the buzzer sounds.For the setting of the utility call key, refer to the following.
MODBUS(R)/TCP
User's Manual of GOT used.
CONNECTION
(3) Communication interface setting by the Utility
The communication interface setting can be changed on the Utility's [Communication setting] after writing
[Communication Settings] of project data.
For details on the Utility, refer to the following manual.
6
User's Manual of GOT used.
CONNECTION TO
(4) Precedence in communication settings
SOUND OUTPUT
When settings are made by GT Designer3 or the Utility, the latest setting is effective.
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
Presetting the system alarm to project data allows you to identify errors occurred on the GOT, PLC CPU, servo
amplifier and communications.
For details on the operation method of the GOT Utility screen, refer to the following manual.
User's Manual of GOT used.
HINT
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
The communication monitoring is a function that checks whether the PLC can communicate with the GOT.
If this check ends successfully, it means correct communication interface settings and proper cable connection. 2
Display the communication monitoring function screen by [Main Menu] [Comm. Setting] [Comm. Monitor].
MICROCOMPUTER
For details on the communication monitoring function, refer to the following manual:
CONNECTION
GT10 User's Manual
(SERIAL)
(Operation of communication monitoring function screen)
Main Menu
3
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
Touch [Comm. Setting] Touch [ ]
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
Communication settings
MODBUS(R)/TCP
Touch [Comm. Monitor]
CONNECTION
Write data to virtual devices inside GOT (For microcomputer connection)
6
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
Send a message from the host to the GOT, and confirm that the values are stored in the virtual devices inside the
UNIT
GOT.
( 2.7 System Configuration Examples) 7
Write command
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
S E
T RW 0100 000A 0163 0362 T D3
X X
DEVICE
Microcomputer board
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
2.
Click!
1.
PROCEDURES FOR
The Ping test can be confirmed by the Utility screen of the GOT.
PREPARATORY
For the operation method of GOT Utility, refer to the following.
MONITORING
GT16 User's Manual (Basic Utility)
GT14 User's Manual
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(SERIAL)
3
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
4
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
5
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
6
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
The station monitoring function detects the faults (communication timeout) of the stations monitored by the GOT.
When detecting the abnormal state, it is assigning the information of the faulty station to the GOT special register
(GS).
(1) No. of faulty stations
(a) For the Ethernet connection (except for the Ethernet multiple connection)
The total No. of the faulty CPUs is stored.
Device b15 to b8 b7 to b0
GS230 (00Hfixed) No. of faulty stations
POINT
When monitoring GS230 on Numerical Display
When monitoring GS230 on Numerical Display, check [mask processing] with data operation tab as the following.
For the data operation, refer to the following manual.
GT Designer3 Version1 Screen Design Manual
PROCEDURES FOR
The bit corresponding to the faulty station is set. (0: Normal 1: Abnormal)The bit is reset after the fault is
recovered.
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
(a) For the Ethernet connection (except for the Ethernet multiple connection).
GS231 bit 0
GS231 bit 1
2
GS231 bit 2
MICROCOMPUTER
GS231 bit 3
CONNECTION
(SERIAL)
3
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
Ethernet setting No.
Device
b15 b14 b13 b12 b11 b10 b9 b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0 4
GS231 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
MODBUS(R)/RTU
GS232 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17
CONNECTION
GS233 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33
GS234 64 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49
GS235 80 79 78 77 76 75 74 73 72 71 70 69 68 67 66 65
GS236 96 95 94 93 92 91 90 89 88 87 86 85 84 83 82 81
5
GS237 112 111 110 109 108 107 106 105 104 103 102 101 100 99 98 97
MODBUS(R)/TCP
GS238 128 127 126 125 124 123 122 121 120 119 118 117 116 115 114 113
CONNECTION
(b) For the Ethernet multiple connection or the temperature controller connection
The station number to which each device corresponds changes according to the connection/non
connection with Ethernet.
With Ethernet connection: 1 to 128 6
With other than Ethernet connection: 0 to 127
Example) With Ethernet connection, when PC No. 100 CPU connecting to Ch3 is faulty, GS327.b3 is set.
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
The following table shows the case with Ethernet connection.
Device Station No.
Ch1 Ch2 Ch3 Ch4 b15 b14 b13 b12 b11 b10 b9 b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
UNIT
GS287 GS307 GS327 GS347 112 111 110 109 108 107 106 105 104 103 102 101 100 99 98 97
GS288 GS308 GS328 GS348 128 127 126 125 124 123 122 121 120 119 118 117 116 115 114 113 8
DEVICE CONNECTION
GT Designer3 Screen Design Manual (Fundamentals) Appendix.2.3 GOT special register (GS)
FINGERPRINT
Read IC tag with a RFID reader/writer and check that the read data are written into the PLC CPU.
Detailed settings including sequence programs, device settings and other settings required for monitoring, refer to
the following manual.
GT Designer3 Version1 Screen Design Manual (Functions)
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
2
MICROCOMPUTER
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(SERIAL)
2.
CONNECTION (SERIAL) 3
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
4
2.1 Microcomputer Connection (Serial) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 2
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
2.2 System Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 4
2.3 Connection Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 6
2.4 Device Data Area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 10
5
2.5 Message Formats. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 23
MODBUS(R)/TCP
2.6 GOT Side Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 77
CONNECTION
2.7 System Configuration Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 79
2.8 Device Range that Can Be Set . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 82
2.9 Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2 - 83 6
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
2-1
2. MICROCOMPUTER CONNECTION
(SERIAL)
Screen display
D0 to 4095
D100 000A
Display(D4 to 9) Device data area
04/06/01 18:46:49 (Virtual devices)*2
D163 0362
Input(D20) 4. 2.
D4095
1254
Interrupt
Write,Read Command output 3. Response
message *1
1. Request
message *1
S E
T RW 0100 000A 0163 0362 T D3
X X Host
Microcomputer board
POINT
Virtual devices inside the GOT 1. The host sends a request message (the read/write
The devices inside the GOT are used in the command) to the GOT.
microcomputer connection.
(PLC devices are not used) 2. The GOT performs a read/write processing to its
virtual devices according to the request from the host.
2.4 Device Data Area
3. Upon completion of the processing, the GOT sends a
response message (processing result) to the host.
PROCEDURES FOR
GOT
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
Screen data
Device data area
Screen display (virtual devices)*2
1.
Interrupt(D13) D13 3139H
2
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(SERIAL)
output value1 output value2
MICROCOMPUTER
Host
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
4
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
1. Data are written to the virtual devices for interrupt
output from the touch switches on the GOT. 5
2. The GOT sends the written data (interrupt output) to
MODBUS(R)/TCP
the host.
CONNECTION
*1 2.5 Message Formats
*2 2.4 Device Data Area
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
Computer
Host GOT
Connection cable
Differs GT15-RS2T4-9P*1
according to
RS-422 RS-422 connection diagram 2) GT15-RS4-9S
host side
specifications
- (Built into GOT)
*1 Connect it to the RS-232 interface (built into GOT). It cannot be mounted on GT1655 and GT155 .
PROCEDURES FOR
Communication driver
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
Computer
GOT GOT
2
Host
(n-th) (n+1th)
MICROCOMPUTER
Connection cable
CONNECTION
(SERIAL)
Varies according to
the connection type. 3
MICROCOMPUTER
Host GOT (n-th) *1 Connection cable GOT (n+1th) *1
Number of
CONNECTION
Commun Commun Max. connectable
(ETHERNET)
Option
Connection type ication Option device Model ication Cable model dis- Model equipment
device
Type Type tance
GT10-C30R2-6P(3m)*2 3m
GT10-C02H-6PT9P(0.2m)
+
- (Built into
GOT)
4
15m *3
RS-232 connection
MODBUS(R)/RTU
RS-232 - (Built into diagram 6)
RS-232
CONNECTION
RS-422 GOT) GT01-C30R2-6P(3m) 3m
GT10-C02H-6PT9P(0.2m)
For the system configuration - (Built into
+
between the GOT and host, 15m GOT)
refer to the following. RS-232 connection
4 GOT for 1
diagram 7)
host 5
When connecting one RS-422 connection - (Built into
30m
GOT - (Built into diagram 4) GOT) *4
MODBUS(R)/TCP
RS-232 RS-422
GOT)
CONNECTION
RS-422 connection - (Built into
30m
diagram 5) GOT)
CONNECTION TO
*1 This is the connection type (for n-th and n+1th from the host) of GOT, which is connected to the host.
SOUND OUTPUT
*2 For the connection to GOT, refer to the connection diagram. ( RS-232 connection diagram 3))
*3 The n+1th GOT must be a RS-232 built-in product.
*4 The n+1th GOT must be a RS-422 built-in product (input power supply: 24V).
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
RS -
CD/NC*1 1 FG
CS -
RD(RXD) 2 SD(TXD)
NC ER(DTR)
SD(TXD) 3 RD(RXD)
NC FG
ER(DTR) 4 RS(RTS)
SG 5 SG
Example of the case where the DTR/DSR signal is used
DR(DSR) 6 CS(CTS)
GOT side
RS(RTS) 7 - (terminal block) Host side
CS(CTS) 8 -
SD RD(RXD)
- 9 ER(DTR)
RD SD(TXD)
*1 GT16: CD, GT15: CD, GT14: NC, GT12: NC, GT11: NC, ER DR(DSR)
GT105 : NC, GT104 : NC
DR ER(DTR)
Example of the case where the DTR/DSR signal is used SG SG
GOT side Host side RS RS(RTS)
CD/NC *1 1 FG CS CS(CTS)
RD(RXD) 2 SD(TXD) NC 5V
SD(TXD) 3 RD(RXD) NC FG
ER(DTR) 4 DR(DSR)
Yellow DR
Green SG
Purple RS
CS
NC
NC
PROCEDURES FOR
(For GT105 , GT104 , GT1030, GT1020) Cable (GT10-C02H-6PT9P)
2nd GOT side
PREPARATORY
Connection diagram for connecting GT105 or GT104 to GT1030 or 9-pin D-sub side
MONITORING
GT1020
N.C. 1 1 N.C.
GT105 , GT103 ,
GT104 side GT102 side RD(RXD) 2 3 SD(TXD)
SD(TXD) 3 2 RD(RXD)
2
N.C. 1 RS(RTS)
ER(DTR) 4 6 DR(DSR)
RD(RXD) 2 SD(TXD)
SG SG
MICROCOMPUTER
5 5
SD(TXD) 3 RD(RXD)
DR(DSR) 6 4 ER(DTR)
CONNECTION
ER(DTR) 4 DR(DSR)
RS(RTS) 7 8 CS(CTS)
(SERIAL)
SG 5 SG
CS(CTS) 8 7 RS(RTS)
DR(DSR) 6 ER(DTR)
9
RS(RTS) 7 CS(CTS)
3
CS(CTS) 8 N.C.
MICROCOMPUTER
9 N.C.
Precautions when preparing a cable
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
(1) Cable length
RS-232 connection diagram 5) The length of the RS-232 cable must be 15m or less.
(For GT105 , GT104 ) (2) GOT side connector
Connection diagram for connecting GT105
GT104
or GT104 to GT105 or
For the GOT side connector, refer to the following. 4
1.4.1 GOT connector specifications
GOT side GOT side
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
N.C. 1 1 N.C.
RD(RXD) 2 3 SD(TXD)
SD(TXD) 3 2 RD(RXD)
ER(DTR) 4 6 DR(DSR)
5
SG 5 5 SG
MODBUS(R)/TCP
DR(DSR) 6 4 ER(DTR)
CONNECTION
RS(RTS) 7 8 CS(CTS)
CS(CTS) 8 7 RS(RTS)
9 9
6
RS-232 connection diagram 6)
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
Cable (GT10-C02H-6PT9P) 2nd GOT side
9-pin D-sub side (terminal block)
N.C. 1 6 RS
UNIT
RD(RXD) 2 1 SD(TXD)
SD(TXD) 3 2 RD(RXD) 7
ER(DTR) 4 4 DR(DSR)
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
SG 5 5 SG
DR(DSR) 6 3 ER(DTR)
DEVICE
RS(RTS) 7 7 CS(CTS)
CS(CTS) 8 8 N.C.
9 9 N.C.
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
RDB2(RXD2-) 8 -
TXD+(SDA) 1 RXD+(RDA)
RS-422 connection diagram 2)
TXD-(SDB) 6 RXD-(RDB)
(For GT16, GT15, GT14, GT12, GT11, GT105 ,
SG 5 SG
GT104 )
GOT side Host side CTS+(CSA) 4 RTS+(RSA)
CTS-(CSB) 9 RTS-(RSB)
RDA 2 SDA
RTS+(RSA) 3 CTS+(CSA)
RDB 7 SDB
RTS-(RSB) 8 CTS-(CSB)
SDA 1 RDA
SDB 6 RDB
RSB 8 -
(For GT105 , GT104 )
Connection diagram for connecting GT105 or GT104 to GT105 or
CSA 4 - GT104
CSB 9 - GOT side GOT side
SG 5 SHELL TXD+(SDA) 1 2 RXD+(RDA)
RXD+(RDA) 2 1 TXD+(SDA)
RTS+(RSA) 3 4 CTS+(CSA)
CTS+(CSA) 4 3 RTS+(RSA)
SG 5 5 SG
TXD-(SDB) 6 7 RXD-(RDB)
RXD-(RDB) 7 6 TXD-(SDB)
RTS-(RSB) 8 9 CTS-(CSB)
CTS-(CSB) 9 8 RTS-(RSB)
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
The polarity A and B in signal names may be reversed
depending on the microcomputer to be used.
Prepare a cable according to the microcomputer to be
used.
2
MICROCOMPUTER
Precautions when preparing a cable
CONNECTION
(1) Cable length
(SERIAL)
The distance between the GOT and the PLC of
connection diagram 1), 2) and 3) must be 1200 m or
less.
The length of the RS-422 connection diagram 4) or RS- 3
422 connection diagram 5) must be 30m or less.
MICROCOMPUTER
(2) GOT side connector
CONNECTION
For the GOT side connector, refer to the following.
(ETHERNET)
1.4.1 GOT connector specifications
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
(a) For GT16, GT15, GT12
Set the terminating resistor setting switch of the
GOT main unit to "Disable".
(b) For GT14, GT11, GT10
Set the terminating resistor selector to "330 ".
For the procedure to set the terminating resistor, refer 5
to the following.
MODBUS(R)/TCP
1.4.3 Terminating resistors of GOT
CONNECTION
6
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
*3 Access to SD3 to 9 can also be made by the specification of the addresses (3000 to 300DH) of GD0 to 6 on the GOT-F900 Series.
POINT
Values of virtual devices inside the GOT
When the GOT is turned OFF or reset, values are cleared to their defaults
(bit devices: OFF, word devices: 0).
Values are held in the memory when project data are written to the GOT.
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
The D devices are word devices into which GOT communication errors, clock data or other information are stored.
MONITORING
The user can also store data using the user area.
List of D devices
The following lists the D devices (virtual devices inside the GOT).
2
Address Description Set side
MICROCOMPUTER
D0 to 2 Unused ―
CONNECTION
Communication error status
Stores the communication error details of GOT.
(SERIAL)
0: Normal
1: Error
b15 – b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 – b0 3
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
Unused
D3 SIO framing error
SIO parity error
SIO overrun error
Communication timeout
error
4
Unused
MODBUS(R)/RTU
• b4 to 6 turn ON when an SIO error occurs, and turn OFF when an request message from the host is received
CONNECTION
successfully after the error occurrence.
• b7 turns ON about 3 seconds after the host side DTR becomes OFF, and turns OFF when transmission is
performed successfully to the host after the error occurrence.
b15 – b8 b7 – b0 5
System
MODBUS(R)/TCP
D4
CONNECTION
Lower 2 digits of calendar
year stored as 2-digit BCD
Unused
CONNECTION TO
D5 SOUND OUTPUT
Data of months 01 to
UNIT
12 stored as 2-digit BCD
Unused
7
Clock data (day)
CONNECTION TO
b15 – b8 b7 – b0
EXTERNAL I/O
D6
DEVICE
Data of days 01 to
31 stored as 2-digit BCD
Unused 8
DEVICE CONNECTION
b15 – b8 b7 – b0
D7
Data of hours 00 to
23 stored as 2-digit BCD
Unused
b15 – b8 b7 – b0
D8
Data of minutes 00 to
59 stored as 2-digit BCD
Unused
D9
Data of seconds 00 to
59 stored as 2-digit BCD
Unused
b15 – b8 b7 – b0
PROCEDURES FOR
Address Description Set side
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
Interrupt output
When data are written to D13 and D14 from a GOT touch switch, for example, the data of D13
and D14 are transmitted (interrupt output) to the host side.*1*2
The data amount (number of bytes) to be interrupt-output is set at "Interrupt Data Byte" in
"Communication Detail Settings".(
settings))
2.6.1 Setting communication interface (Communication
2
D13
MICROCOMPUTER
• Output value when 1 is set to "Interrupt Data Byte" in "Communication Detail Settings"
CONNECTION
D13
(SERIAL)
Lower 8 bits
3
1 byte
• Output value when 2 is set to "Interrupt Data Byte" in "Communication Detail Settings"
MICROCOMPUTER
D13
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits User
2 bytes
• Output value when 4 is set to "Interrupt Data Byte" in "Communication Detail Settings
"(1) When setting the LH order to [32bit Storage] for the communication detail settings
4
MODBUS(R)/RTU
D14 D13
CONNECTION
D14
Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits
4 bytes
(2) When setting the HL order to [32bit Storage] for the communication detail settings
5
D13 D14
MODBUS(R)/TCP
Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits
CONNECTION
4 bytes
D15 to 19 Unused ―
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
1-second binary counter
The counter is incremented at 1-second intervals after the GOT is turned ON.
D2035 System
(The time elapsed after GOT is turned ON is stored in 1-second units.)
Data are stored in binary format.
UNIT
*1 After writing data, the interrupt data is output within a period of 1 to 10ms.
EXTERNAL I/O
*2 When data are written to D13 and D14 from the host side, interrupt output is not performed.
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
: : : : : :
: : - :
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
The R devices are word devices into which user data are stored.
MONITORING
All of these devices can be used as a user area.
MICROCOMPUTER
Address specification value
CONNECTION
Model Address Format Format Format Format Format
1, 2 3 to 6 7 to 10 11 to 13 14, 15
(SERIAL)
0000H 0000H 0001H
R0 4096 R0 R0 1000H
0001H Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits 3
MICROCOMPUTER
0002H 0002H 0003H
R1 4097 R1 R1 1001H
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
0003H Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits
: : : : : :
MODBUS(R)/RTU
0000H 0000H 0001H
CONNECTION
R0 4096 -
0001H Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
1FFEH 1FFEH 1FFFH
R4095 8191 -
1FFFH Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits
*1 For the address specification method for each data format, refer to the following.
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
The L devices are bit devices into which user data are stored.
All of these devices can be used as a user area.
L7 L6 L5 L4 L3 L2 L1 L0 A000H
8192 2000H
L15 L14 L13 L12 L11 L10 L9 L8 A001H
L7 L6 L5 L4 L3 L2 L1 L0 - A000H
8192
L15 L14 L13 L12 L11 L10 L9 L8 - A001H
: : - :
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
The M devices are bit devices into which user data are stored.
MONITORING
All of these devices can be used as a user area.
MICROCOMPUTER
Address Address specification value
CONNECTION
Model Format Format Format Format Format
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
1, 2 3 to 6 7 to 10 11 to 13 14, 15
(SERIAL)
M7 M6 M5 M4 M3 M2 M1 M0 2000H
8320 2080H
M15 M14 M13 M12 M11 M10 M9 M8 2H001H
MICROCOMPUTER
column on left
*2
: : : :
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
M2039 M2038 M2037 M2036 M2035 M2034 M2033 M2032 20FEH
8447 20FFH
M2047 M2046 M2045 M2044 M2043 M2042 M2041 M2040 20FFH
M7 M6 M5 M4 M3 M2 M1 M0 - 2000H
MODBUS(R)/RTU
M31 M30 M29 M28 M27 M26 M25 M24 - 2003H
CONNECTION
: : - :
MODBUS(R)/TCP
• Formats 1, 2 : GOT-A900 Series microcomputer connection
CONNECTION
• Formats 3 to 6 : A compatible 1C frame
• Formats 7 to 10 : QnA compatible 3C/4C frame
• Formats 11 to 13 : Digital Electronics Corporation's memory link method
• Formats 14, 15 : GOT-F900 Series microcomputer connection
*2 For reading or writing data in word units, specify the addresses in 16-point units.(Example: M0, M16, M32, and others)
6
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
The SD devices are word devices into which GOT communication errors (error codes), clock data and other information
are stored.
List of SD devices
The following lists the SD devices (virtual devices inside the GOT).
SD1 SD0
SD0
SD1 Upper word Lower word
(2) When setting the HL order to [32bit Storage] for the communication detail settings
The upper and lower bits are stored in SD0 and SD1 respectively.
SD0 SD1
■ Details and actions for errors (error codes) stored into SD2
PROCEDURES FOR
Address Description Set side
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
Clock data (year)
SD8
4-digit year data is stored.
MICROCOMPUTER
SD10 to 15 Unused ―
*1 If a wrong day of the week is set by the clock data setting commands, the clock data will differ from the time displayed on the
CONNECTION
utility.
(SERIAL)
Example: When June 1, 2004 (Thursday) is set by the clock data setting command (the actual day of the week is Tuesday),
"4" is stored to SD9 although Tuesday (TUE) will be displayed on the utility time display.
POINT 3
MICROCOMPUTER
The side where virtual devices are set
CONNECTION
System : Set on the system side.
(ETHERNET)
User : Set on the user side (by sending request messages from host or using the touch switches, etc.
on the GOT).
4
Details and actions for errors (error codes) stored into SD2
MODBUS(R)/RTU
Error code Description Action
CONNECTION
0 No error ―
2, 102
Framing error
The data bit and/or stop bit are not correct.
• Check the settings of "Communication Detail Settings".
• Match the GOT and host transmission settings.
5
Overrun error
MODBUS(R)/TCP
• Check the settings of "Communication Detail Settings".
3, 103 The next data was transmitted from the host before GOT
CONNECTION
• Decrease the transmission speed.
completes the processing of the data received.
The RS-232 port is occupied. • Check the settings of "Communication Detail Settings".
EXTERNAL I/O
6, 107 • Check whether the non-existent data is set (e.g. setting "07"
The setting value of the clock data has error.
at the day of the week) as clock data.
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
2106H
(3000H) 2106H(3000H) 2107H(3001H)
SD3 8451 D9003 SD3 2103H
2107H
Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits
(3001H)
2108H
(3002H) 2108H(3002H) 2109H(3003H)
SD4 8452 D9004 SD4 2104H
2109H
Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits
(3003H)
210AH
(3004H) 210AH(3004H) 210BH(3005H)
SD5 8453 D9005 SD5 2105H
210BH
Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits
(3005H)
210CH
(3006H) 210CH(3006H) 210DH(3007H)
SD6 8454 D9006 SD6 2106H
210DH
Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits
(3007H)
210EH
(3008H) 210EH(3008H) 210FH(3009H)
SD7 8455 D9007 SD7 2107H
210FH
Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits
(3009H)
2110H
(300AH) 2110H(300AH) 2111H(300BH)
SD8 8456 D9008 SD8 2108H
2111H
Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits
(300BH)
2112H
(300CH) 2112H(300CH) 2113H(300DH)
SD9 8457 D9009 SD9 2109H
2113H
Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits
(300DH)
*1 For the address specification method for each data format, refer to the following.
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
The SM devices are bit devices into which interrupt outputs and clock data that turn ON/OFF at 1-second cycles.
MONITORING
List of SM devices
The following shows the SM devices (virtual devices inside the GOT).
MICROCOMPUTER
When the ON/OFF state of SM0 to 49 is changed by a touch switch on the GOT, for example, the interrupt
codes shown below are transmitted (interrupt output) to the host side.*1*2
CONNECTION
The data amount (number of bytes) to be interrupt-output is set at "Interrupt Data Byte" in "Communication
(SERIAL)
Detail Settings". ( 2.6.1 Setting communication interface (Communication settings))
SM0
Changed from OFF to ON 50H 3
Changed from ON to OFF 51H
MICROCOMPUTER
Changed from OFF to ON 52H
SM0 to 49 User
CONNECTION
SM1
(ETHERNET)
Changed from ON to OFF 53H
Changed from OFF to ON 54H
SM2
Changed from ON to OFF 55H
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
Changed from OFF to ON B2H
SM49
Changed from ON to OFF B3H
MODBUS(R)/TCP
System
2-second cycle clock
CONNECTION
Turns ON/OFF at a 2-second cycle.
SM51
1 1
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
When set to disable the interrupt code output, no interrupt data are output to the host.
(Relevant devices: D13, D14, SM0 to 49)
SM53 to 63 Unused ―
UNIT
*1 After the ON/OFF state is changed, the interrupt data is output within a period of 1 to 10 ms.
*2 When the ON/OFF state of SM0 to 49 is changed from the host side, interrupt output is not performed.
7
POINT
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
User : Set on the user side (by sending request messages from host or using the touch switches, etc.
on the GOT).
(2) Interrupt outputs (SM0 to 49) 8
• To disable the interrupt output, turn ON SM52 (interrupt code output disable flag).( 2.4.6 SM devices)
DEVICE CONNECTION
• To enable the interrupt output, set 8 bits to the data length at "Communication Detail Settings".
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
This section describes the format of messages that can be used in the microcomputer connection (serial).
MICROCOMPUTER
Communication is possible using any of the data formats shown below.
CONNECTION
(1) Formats 1, 2 (GOT-A900 Series microcomputer connection)
(SERIAL)
This is the same message format as when a microcomputer connection is established with the GOT-A900
series.
MICROCOMPUTER
GOT-A900 Series microcomputer connection This format is used when the GOT is connected to the host in a 1:1
Format 1
(format 1) connection.
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
2.5.3
GOT-A900 Series microcomputer connection This is the appended format with error code at the error response of the
Format 2
(format 2) GOT-A900 Series microcomputer connection (format 1).
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
Type Name Description Refer to
Format 3 A compatible 1C frame (format 1) This is the basic format of the dedicated protocols.
MODBUS(R)/TCP
This is the appended format of the A compatible 1C frame (format 1) with
Format 6 A compatible 1C frame (format 4)
CONNECTION
CR and LF.
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
Format 7 QnA compatible 3C/4C frame (format 1) This is the basic format of the MC protocols.
This is the appended format of the QnA compatible 3C/4C frame (format 1)
Format 8 QnA compatible 3C/4C frame (format 2)
with block No.
UNIT
This is the enclosed format of the QnA compatible 3C/4C frame (format 1) 2.5.5
Format 9 QnA compatible 3C/4C frame (format 3)
with STX and ETX.
7
This is the appended format of the QnA compatible 3C/4C frame (format 1)
Format 10 QnA compatible 3C/4C frame (format 4)
with CR and LF.
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
Use this format when establishing a 1:1 or m:n connection between the
GOT-F900 Series microcomputer connection
Format 14 GOT and the host.
(format 1)
The end code is CR.
2.5.7
Use this format when establishing a 1:1 or m:n connection between the
GOT-F900 Series microcomputer connection
Format 15 GOT and the host.
(format 2)
The end code is ETX or sum check.
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
The following shows the list of commands available in each data format.
MONITORING
List of commands for formats 1, 2 (GOT-A900 Series microcomputer connection)
Command
Symbol
ASCII Command name Description
Max. number of points
processed 2
code
MICROCOMPUTER
Batch read Reads bit devices in 16-point units. 64 words (1024 points)
RD 52H 44H
CONNECTION
in word units Reads word devices in 1-point units. 64 points
(SERIAL)
Batch write Writes to bit devices in 16-point units. 64 words (1024 points)
WD 57H 44H
in word units Writes to word devices in 1-point units. 64 points
RR 52H 52H
Random read Reads multiple different bit devices in 16-point units. 64 words (1024 points)
3
in word units*1 Reads multiple different word devices in 1-point units. 64 points
MICROCOMPUTER
Random write Writes to multiple different word devices in 16-point units. 64 words (1024 points)
RW 52H 57H
CONNECTION
in word units*1
(ETHERNET)
Writes to multiple different word devices in 1-point units. 64 points
TR 54H 52H Read clock data Reads the clock data of the GOT. ―
TS 54H 53H Set clock data Sets the clock data of the GOT. ―
*1 Mixed specification of bit devices and word devices is also possible.
4
List of commands for formats 3 to 6 (A compatible 1C frame)
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
Command
Max. number of points
ASCII Command name Description
Symbol processed
code
BR
JR
42H 52H
4AH 52H
Batch read
in bit units
Reads bit devices in 1-point units. 64 points 5
WR 57H 52H Batch read Reads bit devices in 16-point units.*3 64 words (1024 points)
MODBUS(R)/TCP
QR 51H 52H in word units
CONNECTION
Reads word devices in 1-point units. 64 points
WW 57H 57H Batch write Writes to bit devices in 16-point units.*3 64 words (1024 points)
QW 51H 57H in word units Writes to word devices in 1-point units. 64 points 6
BT 42H 54H Test in bit units
Writes to multiple different bit devices in 1-point units. 64 points
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
JT 4AH 54H (random write)
WT 57H 54H Test in word units Writes to multiple different bit devices in 16-point units.*3 64 words (1024 points)
QT 51H 54H (random write) Writes to multiple different word devices in 1-point units. 64 points
UNIT
TR*2 54H 52H Read clock data Reads the clock data of the GOT. ―
TS*2 54H 53H Set clock data Sets the clock data of the GOT. ― 7
*2 This is a dedicated command of GOT for the microcomputer connection.
CONNECTION TO
*3 Specifies the address of bit devices in 16-point units. (Example: M0, M16, M32, and others)
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
Batch read
0401 0001 Reads bit devices in 1-point units. 64 points
in bit units
Batch read Reads bit devices in 16-point units.*3 64 words (1024 points)
0401 0000
in word units Reads word devices in 1-point units. 64 points
Batch write
1401 0001 Writes to bit devices in 1-point units. 64 points
in bit units
Batch write Writes to bit devices in 16-point units.*3 64 words (1024 points)
1401 0000
in word units Writes to word devices in 1-point units. 64 points
Random read Reads multiple different bit devices in 16-point and 32-point units.*3 64 words (1024 points)
0403 0000
in word units*1 Reads multiple different word devices in 1-point and 2-point units. 64 points
Random write
1402 0001 Writes to multiple different bit devices in 1-point units. 64 points
in bit units
Random write Writes to multiple different bit devices in 16-point and 32-point units.*3 64 words (1024 points)
1402 0000 *1
in word units Writes to multiple different word devices in 1-point and 2-point units. 64 points
Multiple block Reads multiple blocks. A bit device (16 bits for 1 point) or a word device
0406 0000 64 points
batch read (1 word for 1 point) is regarded as one block.*3
Multiple block Writes multiple blocks. A bit device (16 bits for 1 point) or a word device
1406 0000 64 points
batch write (1 word for 1 point) is regarded as one block.*3
1901*2 0000 Read clock data Reads the clock data of the GOT. ―
0901*2 0000 Set clock data Sets the clock data of the GOT. ―
List of commands for formats 11 to 13 (Digital Electronics Corporation's memory link method)
Command
Max. number of points
ASCII Command name Description
Symbol processed
code
Batch read Reads bit devices in 16-point units. 64 words (1024 points)
R 52H
in word units Reads word devices in 1-point units. 64 points
Batch write Writes to bit devices in 16-point units. 64 words (1024 points)
W 57H
in word units Writes to word devices in 1-point units. 64 points
*4 4DH Read clock data Reads the clock data of the GOT. ―
N
M*4 4EH Set clock data Sets the clock data of the GOT. ―
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
Command
MONITORING
Max. number of points
ASCII Command name Description
Symbol processed
code
Batch read Reads bit devices in byte units. 255bytes (2040 points)
0 30H
(w/out station No.) Reads word devices in byte units. 255bytes (127 points) 2
Batch read Reads bit devices in byte units. 255bytes (2040 points)
MICROCOMPUTER
A 41H
(w/ station No.) Reads word devices in byte units. 255bytes (127 points)
CONNECTION
Batch write Writes to bit devices in byte units. 255bytes (2040 points)
(SERIAL)
1 31H
(w/out station No.) Writes to word devices in byte units. 255bytes (127 points)
Batch write Writes to bit devices in byte units. 255bytes (2040 points)
B 42H
(w/ station No.) Writes to word devices in byte units. 255bytes (127 points) 3
Multi-point write in bit
MICROCOMPUTER
3 33H
units (w/out station No.) Writes bit patterns (bit ON/OFF, inversion, direct specification) in
70bytes (560 points)
CONNECTION
Multi-point write in bit 1-point units (8 bits for 1 point) to a specified device.
(ETHERNET)
D 44H
units (w/ station No.)
Fill command
4 34H
(w/out station No.)
Writes the same value to a range of specified devices. ―
E 45H
Fill command
(w/ station No.)
4
Set clock data
MODBUS(R)/RTU
5 35H
(w/out station No.)
CONNECTION
Sets the clock data of the GOT. ―
Set clock data
F 46H
(w/ station No.)
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
6
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
Sum
STX Command Data ETX Check
Request message
(host GOT) 02H 03H
(H) (L) (H) (L)
Sum
STX Data ETX Check
02H 03H
(H) (L)
Response message
during normal Sum check is performed in this range.
communication
(GOT host) (2) During processing of write commands
ACK
06H
(format 1: GOT-A900 Series microcomputer connection (format 1)) (format 2: GOT-A900 Series microcomputer connection (format 2))
Response message
NAK Error
during faulty NAK Code
communication
(GOT host)
15H 15H
(format 1: GOT-A900 Series microcomputer connection (format 1)) (format 2: GOT-A900 Series microcomputer connection (format 2))
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
POINT
Data code during communication
Communication is performed in ASCII code. (excluding interrupt output)
2
MICROCOMPUTER
(1) Control codes
CONNECTION
Symbol ASCII code Description
(SERIAL)
STX 02H Start of Text (start marker of message frame)
ETX 03H End of Text (end marker of message frame)
EOT 04H End of Transmission
ENQ 05H Enquiry (start of enquiry)
3
NAK 15H Negative ACK (error response)
MICROCOMPUTER
ACK 06H Acknowledge (write completion response)
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
LF 0AH Line Feed
CL 0CH Clear
CR 0DH Carriage Return
(2) Command
4
Specifies the contents to access from the host to GOT.
MODBUS(R)/RTU
The command is converted to a 2-digit ASCII code (Hex) and transmitted from the upper digit.
CONNECTION
For details of the commands that can be used, refer to the following.
2.5.2 List of commands
(3) Address
Specifies the head No. of the device data to be read/written.
5
The address notated in decimal is converted to a 4-digit ASCII code (Hex) and transmitted from the upper digit.
MODBUS(R)/TCP
For details of the device range that can be accessed, refer to the following.
CONNECTION
2.4 Device Data Area
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
(5) Year, month, day, hour, minute, second and day of the week data
Specifies year, month, day, hour, minute, second, and day of the week to be read/set to the GOT clock data.
The address notated in decimal is converted to a 2-digit ASCII code (Hex) and transmitted from the upper digit. UNIT
Specifies the data to read from/write to the specified device data.(word unit)
The address notated in hexadecimal is converted to a 4-digit ASCII code (Hex) and transmitted from the upper
DEVICE
digit.
Number of Sum
STX Command Address points ETX Check
R D 0 1 0 0 0 2 B C
02H 52H 44H 30H 31H 30H 30H 30H 32H 03H 42H 43H
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
52H + 44H + 30H + 31H + 30H + 30H + 30H + 32H + 03H = 1BCH
PROCEDURES FOR
(1) Batch read in word units (RD) command
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
(a) When reading a word device
The following shows an example of reading the two points of the virtual devices D100 and D101.
(Assuming D100=0102H, D101=0304H are stored.)
2
D100 0102H
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
D101 0304H
(SERIAL)
Item Message format
3
Number of Sum
STX Command Address points ETX Check
MICROCOMPUTER
Request message R D 0 1 0 0 0 2 B C
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
(host GOT) 02H 52H 44H 30H 31H 30H 30H 30H 32H 03H 42H 43H
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
MODBUS(R)/RTU
during normal 0 1 0 2 0 3 0 4 8 D
CONNECTION
communication 02H 30H 31H 30H 32H 30H 33H 30H 34H 03H 38H 44H
(GOT host) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
15H
Response message
during faulty (format 2: GOT-A900 Series microcomputer connection (format 2))
communication
(GOT host) NAK code
Error 6
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
15H 06H
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
M15 to 0 0001H
M31 to 6 8000H
Number of Sum
STX Command Address points ETX Check
Request message R D 8 3 2 0 0 2 C 8
(host GOT) 02H 52H 44H 38H 33H 32H 30H 30H 32H 03H 43H 38H
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
Sum
STX Data 1 (M15 to 0) Data 2 (M31 to 16) ETX Check
0 0 0 1 8 0 0 0 8 C
Response message
02H 30H 30H 30H 31H 38H 30H 30H 30H 03H 38H 43H
during normal
communication (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
(GOT host)
00000000000000011000000000000000
MMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMM
11111198765432103322222222221111
543210 1098765432109876
NAK
15H
Response message
during faulty (format 2: GOT-A900 Series microcomputer connection (format 2))
communication
(GOT host)
Error
NAK code
15H 06H
PROCEDURES FOR
(a) When writing to a word device
PREPARATORY
The following shows as example of writing "0064H"and "0065H"to virtual devices D100 and D101.
MONITORING
D100 0000H D100 0064H
MICROCOMPUTER
Before execution After execution
CONNECTION
Item Message format
(SERIAL)
Number of Sum
STX Command Address points Data 1(D100) Data 2 (D101) ETX Check
Request message W D 0 1 0 0 0 2 0 0 6 4 0 0 6 5 5 6 3
(host GOT) 02H 57H 44H 30H 31H 30H 30H 30H 32H 30H 30H 36H 34H 30H 30H 36H 35H 03H 35H 36H
MICROCOMPUTER
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
Sum check is performed in this range.
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
(format 1: GOT-A900 Series microcomputer connection (format 1))
NAK
15H 5
Response message
MODBUS(R)/TCP
during faulty (format 2: GOT-A900 Series microcomputer connection (format 2))
CONNECTION
communication
(GOT host) NAK code
Error
15H 06H
6
The above is a case where
the sum check error (06H)
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
has occurred.
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
Number Sum
STX Command Address Data 1 (M15 to 0) Data 2 (M31 to 16) ETX
of points Check
W D 8 3 2 0 0 2 0 0 0 1 8 0 0 0 5 6
Request message 02H 57H 44H 38H 33H 32H 30H 30H 32H 30H 30H 30H 31H 38H 30H 30H 30H 03H 35H 36H
(host GOT) (H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L)
00000000000000011000000000000000
MMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMM
11111198765432103322222222221111
543210 1098765432109876
NAK
15H
Response message
during faulty (format 2: GOT-A900 Series microcomputer connection (format 2))
communication
(GOT host) Error
NAK code
15H 06H
PROCEDURES FOR
The following shows an example of reading the two points of the virtual devices D100 and M0 to M15.
(Assuming D100=0064H, M0=1are stored.)
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
D100 0064H
M15 to 0 0001H
2
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
Item Message format
(SERIAL)
Sum
STX Command Address 1 Address 2 ETX Check
Request message
(host GOT) 02H
R
52H
R
52H
0
30H
1
31H
0
30H
0
30H
8
38H
3
33H
2
32H
0
30H 03H
3
33H
5
35H
3
(H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L)
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
Sum check is performed in this range.
(ETHERNET)
Sum check is performed in this range.
Sum
STX Data 1 (D100) Data 2 (M15 to 0) ETX Check
4
0 0 6 4 0 0 0 1 8 E
Response message
02H 30H 30H 36H 34H 30H 30H 30H 31H 03H 38H 45H
MODBUS(R)/RTU
during normal
(H) – – (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L)
CONNECTION
communication
(GOT host)
0000000000000001
MMMMMMMMMMMMMMMM
1111119876543210
543210 5
(format 1: GOT-A900 Series microcomputer connection (format 1))
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
NAK
15H
Response message 6
during faulty (format 2: GOT-A900 Series microcomputer connection (format 2))
CONNECTION TO
communication
SOUND OUTPUT
(GOT host) Error
NAK code
UNIT
15H 06H
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
Sum
STX Command ETX Check
R W Following*1 C 5
02H 52H 57H 03H 43H 35H
(H) (L) (H) (L)
*1
Request message
(host GOT) Address 1 Data 1 (D100) Address 2 Data 2 (M15 to 0)
0 1 0 0 0 0 6 4 8 3 2 0 0 0 0 1
30H 31H 30H 30H 30H 30H 36H 34H 38H 33H 32H 30H 30H 30H 30H 31H
(H) – – (L) (H) – – (L) (H) – – (L) (H) – – (L)
0000000000000001
MMMMMMMMMMMMMMMM
1111119876543210
543210
NAK
15H
Response message
during faulty (format 2: GOT-A900 Series microcomputer connection (format 2))
communication
(GOT host) Error
NAK code
15H 06H
PROCEDURES FOR
The following shows an example of reading the clock data of GOT.
(Assuming that the clock data of GOT has been set to "2004, June 1, 18:46:49, Tuesday".)
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
Time display
2004/06/01 18:46:49 TUE
2
MICROCOMPUTER
Item Message format
CONNECTION
(SERIAL)
Sum
STX Command ETX Check
Request message T R A 9
(host GOT) 02H 54H
(H)
52H
(L)
03H 41H
(H)
39H
(L)
3
MICROCOMPUTER
Sum check is performed in this range.
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
Second Day-of- Sum
STX Year data Month data Day data Hour data Minute data data week data ETX Check
Response message
during normal 0 4 0 6 0 1 1 8 4 6 4 9 0 2 D 0
communication 02H 30H 34H 30H 36H 30H 31H 31H 38H 34H 36H 34H 39H 30H 32H 03H 44H 30H
(GOT host) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) 4
Sum check is performed in this range.
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
(format 1: GOT-A900 Series microcomputer connection (format 1))
NAK
15H 5
Response message
MODBUS(R)/TCP
during faulty
CONNECTION
(format 2: GOT-A900 Series microcomputer connection (format 2))
communication
(GOT host)
Error
NAK code
15H 06H 6
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
The above is a case where
the sum check error (06H)
has occurred.
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
Time display
2004/06/01 18:46:49 TUE
After execution
Request message T S 0 4 0 6 0 1 1 8 4 6 4 9 0 2 7 7
(host GOT) 02H 54H 53H 30H 34H 30H 36H 30H 31H 31H 38H 34H 36H 34H 39H 30H 32H 03H 37H 37H
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
NAK
15H
Response message
during faulty (format 2: GOT-A900 Series microcomputer connection (format 2))
communication
(GOT host)
Error
NAK code
15H 06H
POINT
When a wrong day of the week has been set by the clock data setting command
If a wrong day of the week is set by the clock data setting commands, the clock data will differ from the time
displayed on the utility.
Example: When June 1, 2004 (Thursday) is set by the clock data setting command (the actual day of week is
Tuesday), Tuesday (TUE) will be displayed on the utility time display.
PROCEDURES FOR
The following shows an example of an interrupt output when data are written to the interrupt output devices (D13
and D14).
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
(Assuming that "3139H" is written to D13 and "AA55H" to D14.)
Example: When the number of interrupt data bytes is 2
D13 3139H
2
MICROCOMPUTER
Interrupt
CONNECTION
(SERIAL)
Interrupt output
Output Output
value 1 value 2
3
31H 39H
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
Item Message format
(1) When [Interrupt Data Byte] in "Communication Detail Settings" is set to "1 byte"
(format 1: in the case of GOT-A900 Series (format 2: in the case of GOT-A900 Series
microcomputer connection
(format 1))
microcomputer connection
(format 2))
4
Output STX Output
value 1 ETX Sum check
MODBUS(R)/RTU
value 1
CONNECTION
3 C
39H 02H 39H 03H 33H 43H
(H) (L)
MODBUS(R)/TCP
(format 1: in the case of GOT-A900 Series (format 2: in the case of GOT-A900 Series
CONNECTION
microcomputer connection microcomputer connection
(format 1)) (format 2))
Output Output
Interrupt output value 1 value 2 STX Output Output
value 1 value 2 ETX Sum check
(GOT host) 6 D
31H 39H 02H 31H 39H 03H 36H
(H)
44H
(L)
6
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
Sum check is performed in this range.
(3) When [Interrupt Data Byte] in "Communication Detail Settings" is set to "4 byte"
(format 1: in the case of GOT-A900 Series (format 2: in the case of GOT-A900 Series
UNIT
6 C
EXTERNAL I/O
AAH 55H 31H 39H 02H AAH 55H 31H 39H 03H 36H 43H
(H) (L)
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
Communication message error • Check the communication cable and communication module attachment.
12H EXT was not found within the upper limit of the receive • Check the settings of "Communication Detail Settings".
buffer. • Review the contents of the message to transmit.
Address error
7AH • Review the contents of the message to transmit.
The start address of the read/write device is out of range.
• Check the devices that can be used and the device ranges.
Exceeded number of points error
7BH ( 2.4 Device Data Area)
The read/write range exceeded the device range.
Precautions
(1) Batch reading/writing crossing over different devices
When using the batch read (RD) or batch write (WD) command, do not batch read/write crossing over the
different devices.
This will cause an error response.
(2) Storage order for 32-bit data
To use the program of GOT-A900 series with [32bit Order] setting to GOT1000 series, set [HL Order] to [32bit
Order] for [Communication Detail Settings] when 32-bit data is set for GOT-A900 series.
With setting [LH Order], the order of upper bits and lower bits are reversed when the GOT displays and writes
32-bit data.
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
2
Basic format of data communication
MICROCOMPUTER
This is the same message format as when communication is performed using the dedicated protocol (A compatible
CONNECTION
1C frame) of the A Series computer link module.
For details of the basic format of data communication, refer to the following manual:
(SERIAL)
MELSEC-Q/L MELSEC Communication Protocol Reference Manual
This section describes items whose settings differ from the dedicated protocol of the A Series computer link modules,
and the dedicated commands for a GOT microcomputer connection. 3
MICROCOMPUTER
Example: Request message for the batch read in word units (QR) command in format 4 (A compatible 1C frame
(format 2))
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
Character A section
MODBUS(R)/RTU
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) – – – – – (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
CONNECTION
Sum check is performed in this range.
MODBUS(R)/TCP
Data code during communication
CONNECTION
Communication is performed in ASCII code.
Station No. is used to identify the GOT with which the host communicates. (Setting range: 0 to 31)
The address notated in decimal is converted to a 2-digit ASCII code (Hex) and transmitted from the upper digit.
The GOT processes only commands whose station No. matches the "Host Address (0 to 31)" set at 7
"Communication Detail Settings". (The message of command whose station No. does not match is ignored.)
CONNECTION TO
(3) Command
Specifies the contents to access from the host to GOT.
The command is converted to a 2-digit ASCII code (Hex) and transmitted from the upper digit. 8
For details of the commands that can be used, refer to the following.
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
(6) Year, month, day, hour, minute, second and day of the week data
Specifies year, month, day, hour, minute, second, and day of the week to be read/set to the GOT clock data.
The address notated in decimal is converted to a 2-digit ASCII code (Hex) and transmitted from the upper digit.
■ (1) Read clock data (TR) command
■ (2) Set clock data (TS) command
POINT
When connecting a microcomputer, etc. that uses the dedicated protocol of the A series computer link module with
the GOT
When connecting a microcomputer, etc. that uses the dedicated protocol of the A series computer link module with
the GOT, correct the commands to use and the device range according to the specifications of GOT.
PROCEDURES FOR
The following shows the message format of the dedicated commands for a microcomputer connection of GOT.
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
(1) Read clock data (TR) command
The following shows an example of reading the clock data of GOT.
(Assuming that the clock data of GOT has been set to "2004, June 1, 18:46:49, Tuesday".)
2
Time display
MICROCOMPUTER
2004/06/01 18:46:49 TUE
CONNECTION
(SERIAL)
Item Message format
MICROCOMPUTER
ENQ Station No. Command Wait Check
Request message
CONNECTION
0 0 0 0 T R 0 9 6
(ETHERNET)
(host GOT)
05H 30H 30H 30H 30H 54H 52H 30H 39H 36H
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
Sum
STX Station No. PLC No. ETX Check
0 0 0 0 Following*1 9 0
02H 30H 30H 30H 30H 03H 39H 30H
Response message
during normal
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
5
communication Sum check is performed in this range.
(GOT host)
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
*1
Minute Second Day-of-
Year data Month data Day data Hour data
data data week data
0 4 0 6 0 1 1 8 4 6 4 9 0 2
30H 34H 30H 36H 30H 31H 31H 38H 34H 36H 34H 39H 30H 32H
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) 6
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
Example: Format 3 (A compatible 1C frame (format 1))
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
Time display
2004/06/01 18:46:49 TUE
After execution
Character C section
Sum
ENQ Station No. PLC No. Command Wait Check
0 0 0 0 T S 0 Following*1 6 4
05H 30H 30H 30H 30H 54H 53H 30H 36H 34H
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
Request message
(host GOT) Sum check is performed in this range.
*1
Second Day-of-
Year data Month data Day data Hour data Minute data
data week data
0 4 0 6 0 1 1 8 4 6 4 9 0 2
30H 34H 30H 36H 30H 31H 31H 38H 34H 36H 34H 39H 30H 32H
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
Response message
ACK Station No. PLC No.
during normal
communication 0 0 0 0
(GOT host) 06H 30H 30H 30H 30H
(H) (L) (H) (L)
POINT
When a wrong day of the week has been set by the clock data setting command
If a wrong day of the week is set by the clock data setting commands, the clock data will differ from the time
displayed on the utility.
Example: When June 1, 2004 (Thursday) is set by the clock data setting command (the actual day of week is
Tuesday), Tuesday (TUE) will be displayed on the utility time display.
PROCEDURES FOR
The following shows error code, error contents, cause, and measures.
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
Error code Description Action
MICROCOMPUTER
from the sum check code in the receive data.
CONNECTION
Protocol error
Received a message that does not follow the control • Check the settings of "Communication Detail Settings".
(SERIAL)
03H
procedure of the format set at "Communication Detail • Review the contents of the message to transmit.
Settings".
05H
Overrun error
The next data was transmitted from the host before GOT
• Check the settings of "Communication Detail Settings". 3
• Decrease the transmission speed.
completes the processing of the data received.
MICROCOMPUTER
Character section error • Review the contents of the message to transmit.
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
The character section specification error. • Check the commands in the message.
•The method of specifying the character section is wrong.
( 2.5.2 List of commands)
•The specified command has error.
06H • Check the devices that can be used and the device ranges.
•The number of points of the processing requests exceeds
the allowable range. ( 2.4 Device Data Area)
•A non-existent device has been specified. • Check whether the non-existent data is set (e.g. setting "07" at the day of 4
•The setting value of the clock data has error. the week) as clock data.
MODBUS(R)/RTU
Character error
CONNECTION
07H A character other than "A to Z", "0 to 9", space, and control • Review the contents of the message to transmit.
codes has been received.
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
6
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
Example: Request message for the batch read in word units (0401) command in format 8 (QnA compatible 4C frame
(format 2))
Following
0 0 F 8 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 B A
*1
05H 30H 30H 46H 38H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 42H 41H
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
Character A section
*1
0 4 0 1 0 0 0 0 D * 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 2
30H 34H 30H 31H 30H 30H 30H 30H 44H 2AH 30H 30H 30H 31H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 32H
(H) – – (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) – – – – (L) (H) – – (L)
POINT
QnA compatible 4C frame (format 5)
GOT cannot use the QnA compatible 4C frame (format 5).
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
POINT
Data code during communication
Communication is performed in ASCII code.
2
MICROCOMPUTER
(1) Block No., network No., PLC No., request destination module I/O No. and station No.
CONNECTION
Ignored in a microcomputer connection of the GOT.
Specify "00". (The request destination module I/O No. is "0000".)
(SERIAL)
"00" is converted to a 2-digit ASCII code (Hex) and transmitted from the upper digit.
(The request destination module I/O No. is 4-digit.)
3
(2) Station No.
MICROCOMPUTER
Station No. is used to identify the GOT with which the host communicates.(Setting range: 0 to 1FH)
The address notated in hexadecimal is converted to a 2-digit ASCII code (Hex) and transmitted from the upper
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
digit.
The GOT processes only commands whose station No. matches the "Host Address (0 to 31)" set at
"Communication Detail Settings". (The message of command whose station No. does not match is ignored.)
For setting method of "Communication Detail Settings", refer to the following.
2.6.1 Setting communication interface (Communication settings)
4
MODBUS(R)/RTU
(3) Command, sub-command
CONNECTION
Specifies the contents to access from the host to GOT.
The command is converted to a 4-digit ASCII code (Hex) and transmitted from the upper digit.
For details of the commands that can be used, refer to the following.
2.5.2 List of commands 5
(4) Device code
MODBUS(R)/TCP
Specifies the code by which the device data to be read/written is recognized.
CONNECTION
The command is converted to a 2-digit ASCII code (Hex) and transmitted from the upper digit.
For details of the device range that can be accessed, refer to the following.
2.4 Device Data Area
6
(5) Head device
Specifies the head No. of the device data to be read/written.
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
The address notated in decimal is converted to a 6-digit ASCII code (Hex) and transmitted from the upper digit.
For details of the device range that can be accessed, refer to the following.
2.4 Device Data Area
UNIT
digit.
When specifying multiple devices as follows, limit the total device points to within 64 points.
DEVICE
When setting multiple blocks, limit the total number of points of all blocks to within 64 points.
FINGERPRINT
POINT
When connecting a microcomputer, etc. that uses the MC protocol of the Q/QnA series serial communication
module with the GOT
When connecting a microcomputer, etc. that uses the MC protocol of the Q/QnA series serial communication
module with the GOT, correct the commands to be used and the device ranges to match the GOT specifications.
PROCEDURES FOR
The following shows the message format of the dedicated commands for a microcomputer connection of GOT.
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
(1) Read clock data (1901) command
The following shows an example of reading the clock data of GOT.
(Assuming that the clock data of GOT has been set to "2004, June 1, 18:46:49, Tuesday".)
2
Time display
MICROCOMPUTER
2004/06/01 18:46:49 TUE
CONNECTION
(SERIAL)
Item Message format
MICROCOMPUTER
No. No. module station No.
module I/O No.
F 8 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Following A 9
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
*1
05H 46H 38H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 41H 39H
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
4
(host GOT)
Character A section
*1
Host
Command Sub-command
MODBUS(R)/RTU
Address No.
CONNECTION
0 0 1 9 0 1 0 0 0 0
30H 30H 31H 39H 30H 31H 30H 30H 30H 30H
(H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) – – (L)
MODBUS(R)/TCP
Following
CONNECTION
F 8 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 *1 E E
02H 46H 38H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 03H 43H 43H
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
Response message
during normal Sum check is performed in this range.
communication
(GOT host) *1
Character B section 6
Host Second Day-of-
CONNECTION TO
Address No. Year data Month data Day data Hour data Minute data
SOUND OUTPUT
data week data
0 0 0 4 0 6 0 1 1 8 4 6 4 9 0 2
30H 30H 30H 34H 30H 36H 30H 31H 31H 38H 34H 36H 34H 39H 30H 32H
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
UNIT
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
Error code
7 F 6 9
37H 46H 36H 39H
(H) – – (L)
The above is the case where a parity error
(7F69H) has occurred.
PROCEDURES FOR
The following shows an example of setting the clock data of GOT.
(Assuming the clock data of GOT is to be set to "2004, June 1, 18:46:49 Tuesday".)
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
Time display
2004/06/01 18:46:49 TUE
2
After execution
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
Item Message format
(SERIAL)
Example: Format 7 (QnA compatible 4C frame (format 1))
Request Host
ENQ Frame ID Station No.
Network
PLC No.
Request destination destination Sum check
No.
F 8 0 0
No.
0 0 0 0 0
module I/O No.
0 0 0
module station No. Address No.
0 0 0 0 Following
7 5
3
*1
MICROCOMPUTER
05H 46H 38H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 37H 35H
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
Sum check is performed in this range.
Character C section
*1
Request message
Command Sub-command
4
(host GOT) 0 9 0 1 0 0 0 0 1)
30H 39H 30H 31H 30H 30H 30H 30H
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
(H) – – (L) (H) – – (L)
Character C section
Year data Month data Day data Hour data Minute data
Second
data
Day-of-
week data
5
1) 0 4 0 6 0 1 1 8 4 6 4 9 0 2
MODBUS(R)/TCP
30H 34H 30H 36H 30H 31H 31H 38H 34H 36H 34H 39H 30H 32H
CONNECTION
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
Response message
during normal
Frame ID
ACK No. Station No.
Network
No.
PLC No.
Request destination
module I/O No.
Request destination
module station No.
Host
Address No. 6
communication F 8 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
(GOT host) 06H 46H 38H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
F 8 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Following*1
15H 46H 38H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
Response message
during faulty
communication
*1
(GOT host)
Error code
7 F 6 9
37H 46H 36H 39H
(H) – – (L)
The above is the case where a
parity error (7F69H) has occurred.
POINT
When a wrong day of the week has been set by the clock data setting command
If a wrong day of the week is set by the clock data setting commands, the clock data will differ from the time
displayed on the utility.
Example: When June 1, 2004 (Thursday) is set by the clock data setting command (the actual day of week is
Tuesday), Tuesday (TUE) will be displayed on the utility time display.
PROCEDURES FOR
The following shows error code, error contents, cause, and measures.
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
Error code Description Action
MICROCOMPUTER
7E41H Specified points exceeding the number of points that can • Review the contents of the message to transmit.
be communicated during random read/write. • Check the devices that can be used and the device ranges.
CONNECTION
Number of data error ( 2.4 Device Data Area)
7E42H
(SERIAL)
The number of requests exceeds the command range.
MICROCOMPUTER
Clock data setting error
7E46H • Check whether the non-existent data is set (e.g. setting "07" at the day of
The setting value of the clock data has error.
CONNECTION
the week) as clock data.
(ETHERNET)
• Review the contents of the message to transmit.
Exceeded number of points error • Check the devices that can be used and the device ranges.
7E4FH
The read/write range exceeded the device range.
( 2.4 Device Data Area)
Character error 4
7F20H A character other than "A to Z", "0 to 9", space, and control • Review the contents of the message to transmit.
codes has been received.
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
Communication message error • Check the communication cable and communication module attachment.
7F23H EXT/CR+LF was not found within the upper limit of the • Check the settings of "Communication Detail Settings".
receive buffer. • Review the contents of the message to transmit.
MODBUS(R)/TCP
• Decrease the transmission speed.
completes the processing of the data received.
CONNECTION
Framing error
7F68H • Check the communication cable and communication module attachment.
The data bit and/or stop bit are not correct.
• Check the settings of "Communication Detail Settings".
Parity error • Match the GOT and host transmission settings.
7F69H
The parity bit does not match.
6
• Check the communication cable and communication module attachment.
Buffer full error
7F6AH • Check the settings of "Communication Detail Settings".
CONNECTION TO
The receive buffer overflowed.
SOUND OUTPUT
• Review the contents of the message to transmit.
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
Example:Request message for the batch read in word units (R) command in format 13 (Digital Electronics
Corporation's memory link method (extended mode, ASCII code 1:n))
Sum
ENQ Station No. ESC Com- Address Number of points CR LF
mand Check
0 0 R 0 0 6 4 0 0 0 2 5 E
05H 30H 30H 1BH 52H 30H 30H 36H 34H 30H 30H 30H 32H 35H 45H 0DH 0AH
(H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L)
POINT
Compatibility with the Digital Electronics Corporation's memory link method
In the case of formats 12 and 13 (Digital Electronics Corporation's memory link method (extended mode)), a
communication error may occur since some communication packets are not compatible with the Digital Electronics
Corporation's memory link method in the communication.
To give the compatibility, turn on the digital compatible signals (GS580 to GS583) of the GOT internal device and
communicate in the fully compatible message format.
Device Function Bit Bit position Settings
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
POINT
Data code during communication
Communication is performed in ASCII code.
2
MICROCOMPUTER
(1) Command
Specifies the contents to access from the host to GOT.
CONNECTION
The command is converted to a 1-digit ASCII code (Hex) and transmitted.
(SERIAL)
For details of the commands that can be used, refer to the following.
2.5.2 List of commands
(2) Station No. 3
Station No. is used to identify the GOT with which the host communicates. (Setting range: 0 to 1FH)
MICROCOMPUTER
The address notated in hexadecimal is converted to a 2-digit ASCII code (Hex) and transmitted from the upper
digit.
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
The GOT processes only commands whose station No. matches the "Host Address (0 to 31)" set at
"Communication Detail Settings". (The message of command whose station No. does not match is ignored.)
For setting method of "Communication Detail Settings", refer to the following.
2.6.2 Communication detail settings 4
(3) Address
Specifies the head No. of the device data to be read/written.
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
The address notated in hexadecimal is converted to a 4-digit ASCII code (Hex) and transmitted from the upper
digit.
For details of the device range that can be accessed, refer to the following.
2.4 Device Data Area
(4) Number of points 5
Specifies the number of device data to be read/written. (Setting range: 1 to 40H)
MODBUS(R)/TCP
The address notated in hexadecimal is converted to a 4-digit ASCII code (Hex) and transmitted from the upper
CONNECTION
digit.
(5) Year, month, day, hour, minute, second and day of the week data
Specifies year, month, day, hour, minute, second, and day of the week to be read/set to the GOT clock data.
The address notated in decimal is converted to a 2-digit ASCII code (Hex) and transmitted from the upper digit.
■ Message format (1) Read clock data (N) command
6
■ Message format (2) Set clock data (M) command
CONNECTION TO
(6) Error code SOUND OUTPUT
This is the response message at faulty communication appended with error contents.
The address notated in hexadecimal is converted to a 2-digit ASCII code (Hex) and transmitted from the upper
UNIT
digit.
For details of error codes generated in formats 12 and 13 (Digital Electronics Corporation's memory link method 7
(extended mode)), refer to the following:
CONNECTION TO
POINT
DEVICE
When connecting a microcomputer, etc. that uses the protocol of the Digital Electronics Corporation's memory link
method with the GOT 8
DEVICE CONNECTION
When connecting a microcomputer, etc. that uses the protocol of the Digital Electronics Corporation's memory link
AUTHENTICATION
method with the GOT, correct the commands to be used and the device ranges to match the specifications of the
FINGERPRINT
GOT.
Time display
2004/06/01 18:46:49 TUE
Example: Format 13 (Digital Electronics Corporation's memory link method (extended mode, ASCII code 1:n))
• Digital compatible signal (GS580 to GS583): OFF (Partly compatible)
Sum
ENQ Station No. ESC Com-
mand CR LF
Check
0 0 N C E
05H 30H 30H 1BH 4EH 43H 45H 0DH 0AH
(H) (L) (H) (L)
Sum
ENQ Station No. ESC Com-
mand CR LF
Check
0 0 N C 9
05H 30H 30H 1BH 4EH 43H 39H 0DH 0AH
(H) (L) (H) (L)
PROCEDURES FOR
Item Message format
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
Example: Format 13 (Digital Electronics Corporation's memory link method (extended mode, ASCII code 1:n))
• Digital compatible signal (GS580 to GS583): OFF (Partly compatible)
Sum
STX Station No. ESC Com- ETX CR LF
mand Check
0 0 A Following *1
8 E 2
02H 30H 30H 1BH 41H 03H 38H 45H 0DH 0AH
MICROCOMPUTER
(H) (L) (H) (L)
CONNECTION
This range Sum check
(SERIAL)
*1
Year data Month data Day data Hour data Minute data Second Day-of-
3
data week data
0 4 0 6 0 1 1 8 4 6 4 9 0 2
30H 34H 30H 36H 30H 31H 31H 38H 34H 36H 34H 39H 30H 32H
MICROCOMPUTER
Response message (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
during normal
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
communication
• Digital compatible signal (GS580 to GS583): ON (Fully compatible)
(GOT host)
Sum
STX Station No. ESC Com- ETX CR LF
mand Check
0 0 A Following*1 8 C 4
02H 30H 30H 1BH 41H 03H 38H 43H 0DH 0AH
(H) (L) (H) (L)
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
This range Sum check
*1
Year data Month data Day data Hour data Minute data Second Day-of-
0 4 0 6 0 1 1 8 4 6
data
4 9
week data
0 2
5
30H 34H 30H 36H 30H 31H 31H 38H 34H 36H 34H 39H 30H 32H
MODBUS(R)/TCP
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
CONNECTION
Example: Format 13 (Digital Electronics Corporation's memory link method (extended mode, ASCII code 1:n))
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
Time display
2004/06/01 18:46:49 TUE
After execution
Example: Format 13 (Digital Electronics Corporation's memory link method (extended mode, ASCII code 1:n))
• Digital compatible signal (GS580 to GS583): OFF (Partly compatible)
Com- Sum
ENQ Station No. ESC mand Check CR LF
0 0 M Following*1 9 A
05H 30H 30H 1BH 4DH 39H 41H 0DH 0AH
(H) (L) (H) (L)
*1
Day-of-
Year data Month data Day data Hour data Minute data Second data week data
0 4 0 6 0 1 1 8 4 6 4 9 0 2
30H 34H 30H 36H 30H 31H 31H 38H 34H 36H 34H 39H 30H 32H
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
Request message
(host GOT)
• Digital compatible signal (GS580 to GS583): ON (Fully compatible)
Com- Sum
ENQ Station No. ESC mand Check CR LF
*1
0 0 M Following 9 5
05H 30H 30H 1BH 4DH 39H 35H 0DH 0AH
(H) (L) (H) (L)
*1
Day-of-
Year data Month data Day data Hour data Minute data Second data week data
0 4 0 6 0 1 1 8 4 6 4 9 0 2
30H 34H 30H 36H 30H 31H 31H 38H 34H 36H 34H 39H 30H 32H
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
Example: Format 13 (Digital Electronics Corporation's memory link method (extended mode, ASCII code 1:n))
Response message
ACK Station No. CR LF
during normal
communication 0 0
(GOT host) 06H 30H 30H 0DH 0AH
(H) (L)
PROCEDURES FOR
Item Message format
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
Example: Format 13 (Digital Electronics Corporation's memory link method (extended mode, ASCII code 1:n))
MICROCOMPUTER
The above is a case where the sum
check error (06H) has occurred.
CONNECTION
(SERIAL)
POINT
When a wrong day of the week has been set by the clock data setting command
3
If a wrong day of the week is set by the clock data setting commands, the clock data will differ from the time
MICROCOMPUTER
displayed on the utility.
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
Example: When June 1, 2004 (Thursday) is set by the clock data setting command (the actual day of week is
Tuesday), Tuesday (TUE) will be displayed on the utility time display.
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
5
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
6
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
D13 3139H
Interrupt
Interrupt output
Output Output
value 1 value 2
31H 39H
Example: Format 13 (Digital Electronics Corporation's memory link method (extended mode, ASCII code 1:n))
• Digital compatible signal (GS580 to GS583): OFF (Partly compatible)
Sum
ENQ Station No. ESC Com-
mand CR LF
Check
0 0 I C 9
05H 30H 30H 1BH 49H 43H 39H 0DH 0AH
(H) (L) (H) (L)
Sum
ENQ Station No. ESC Com-
mand CR LF
Check
0 0 I C 4
05H 30H 30H 1BH 49H 43H 34H 0DH 0AH
(H) (L) (H) (L)
PROCEDURES FOR
Item Message format
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
Example: Format 13 (Digital Electronics Corporation's memory link method (extended mode, ASCII code 1:n))
(1) When [Interrupt Data Byte] in "Communication Detail Settings" is set to "1 byte"
MICROCOMPUTER
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
CONNECTION
This range Sum check is performed.
(SERIAL)
(2) When [Interrupt Data Byte] in "Communication Detail Settings" is set to "2 byte"
MICROCOMPUTER
02H 30H 30H 1BH 49H 33H 31H 33H 39H 03H 46H 39H 0DH 0A H
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
Sum check is performed in this range.
(3) When [Interrupt Data Byte] in "Communication Detail Settings" is set to "4 byte"
MODBUS(R)/RTU
0 0 I A A 5 5 3 1 3 9 E 7
CONNECTION
02H 30H 30H 1BH 49H 41H 41H 35H 35H 33H 31H 33H 39H 03H 45H 37H 0DH 0AH
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
5
POINT
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
Interrupt output
• To disable the interrupt output, turn ON SM52 (interrupt code output disable flag).( 2.4.6 SM devices)
• To issue interrupts in format 11, set the data length to "8 bits" at "Communication Detail Settings".
( 2.6.1 Setting communication interface (Communication settings))
• When "7 bits" is set, the MSB (8th bit) is ignored.(Example: FFH 7FH)
6
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
Command error
10H
An unsupported command was used. • Review the contents of the message to transmit.
• Check the commands in the message.
Message length error
12H The upper limit of the data length that can be received by ( 2.5.2 List of commands)
the GOT has been exceeded.
Timeout error • Check the communication cable and communication module attachment.
FFH There is no response from the GOT, or the station of the • Check the settings of "Communication Detail Settings".
specified address does not exist. • Review the contents of the message to transmit.
Precautions
(1) Batch reading/writing crossing over different devices
When using the batch read (R) or batch write (W) command, do not batch read/write crossing over the different
devices.
This will cause an error response.
(2) Storage order for 32-bit data
To use the program of Digital Electronics Corporation's memory link method with [32bit Order] setting to
GOT1000 series, set [HL Order] to [32bit Order] for [Communication Detail Settings] when 32-bit data is set for
GOT-A900 series.
With setting [LH Order], the order of upper bits and lower bits are reversed when the GOT displays and writes
32-bit data.
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
2
Basic format of data communication
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
Item Message format
(SERIAL)
(format 14: GOT-F900 Series microcomputer connection (format (format 15: GOT-F900 Series microcomputer connection (format
1)) 2))
(1) w/out station No. (1) w/out station No.
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
02H 0DH 02H 03H
(ETHERNET)
(H) (L)
Request message
(host GOT) Sum check is performed in this range.
Sum
4
STX Com- Station No. Data CR STX Com-
mand Station No. Data ETX
mand Check
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
02H 0DH 02H 03H
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
MODBUS(R)/TCP
STX Data CR STX Data ETX
Check
CONNECTION
02H 0DH 02H 03H
Response message (H) (L)
during normal
communication
(GOT host)
Sum check is performed in this range.
6
(2) During processing of write commands
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
ACK
06H
UNIT
communication
EXTERNAL I/O
Output
value
During interrupt
output 1/2/4
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
bytes*1
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
POINT
Data code during communication
Communication is performed in ASCII code. (excluding interrupt output)
(2) Command
Specifies the contents to access from the host to GOT.
The command is converted to a 1-digit ASCII code (Hex) and transmitted.
For details of the commands that can be used, refer to the following.
2.5.2 List of commands
(4) Address
Specifies the head No. of the device data to be read/written.
The address notated in hexadecimal is converted to a 4-digit ASCII code (Hex) and transmitted from the upper
digit.
For details of the device range that can be accessed, refer to the following.
2.4 Device Data Area
PROCEDURES FOR
Specifies the number of bytes of the device data to be batch read/written.(Setting range: 0 to FFH)
The address notated in hexadecimal is converted to a 2-digit ASCII code (Hex) and transmitted from the upper
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
digit.
MICROCOMPUTER
(9) Year, month, day, hour, minute, second and day of the week data
Specifies year, month, day, hour, minute, second, and day of the week to be read/set to the GOT clock data.
CONNECTION
The address notated in decimal is converted to a 2-digit ASCII code (Hex) and transmitted from the upper digit.
(SERIAL)
■ (5) Read clock data (6) command (w/out station No.), read clock data (G) command (w/station
No.)
■ (6) Set clock data (5) command (w/out station No.), set clock data (F) command (w/station No.) 3
MICROCOMPUTER
(10) Data
CONNECTION
Specifies the data to read from/write to the specified device data.(word unit)
(ETHERNET)
The address notated in hexadecimal is converted to a 4-digit ASCII code (Hex) and transmitted from the upper
digit.
MODBUS(R)/RTU
digit.
CONNECTION
(12) Sum check code (for format 15: GOT-F900 series microcomputer connection (format 2) only)
The sum check code is obtained by converting the lower 1 byte (8 bits) of the result (sum), after having added
the sum check target data as binary data, to 2-digit ASCII code (Hex).
5
Number of Sum
STX Command Address points ETX
MODBUS(R)/TCP
Check
CONNECTION
R D 0 1 0 0 0 2 B C
02H 52H 44H 30H 31H 30H 30H 30H 32H 03H 42H 43H
(H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
52H + 44H + 30H + 31H + 30H + 30H + 30H + 32H + 03H = 1BCH
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
R100 3D21H
R101 3604H
Number
STX Com- Station No. Address of bytes CR
mand
A 1 5 0 0 C 8 0 4
02H 41H 31H 35H 30H 30H 43H 38H 30H 34H 0DH
(H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L)
Request message
(format 15: GOT-F900 Series microcomputer connection (format 2))
(host GOT)
Number of Sum
STX Com-
mand Station No. Address bytes ETX Check
A 1 5 0 0 C 8 0 4 E 9
02H 41H 31H 35H 30H 30H 43H 38H 30H 34H 03H 45H 39H
(H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
3 D 2 1 3 6 0 4
02H 33H 44H 32H 31H 33H 36H 30H 34H 0DH
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
Response message
during normal
(format 15: GOT-F900 Series microcomputer connection (format 2))
communication
(GOT host) Data 1 Data 2 Data 3 Data 4 Sum
STX (R100 upper) (R100 lower) (R101 upper) (R101 lower) ETX
Check
3 D 2 1 3 6 0 4 A A
02H 33H 44H 32H 31H 33H 36H 30H 34H 03H 41H 41H
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
PROCEDURES FOR
(Assuming M0="1" and M31="1" are stored.
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
M15 to 0 0001H
M31 to 16 8000H
2
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
Item Message format
(SERIAL)
(format 14: GOT-F900 Series microcomputer connection (format 1))
Com- Number of
STX mand Station No. Address bytes CR
A 1 5 2 0 0 0 0 4
3
MICROCOMPUTER
02H 41H 31H 35H 32H 30H 30H 30H 30H 34H 0DH
(H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L)
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
Request message
(format 15: GOT-F900 Series microcomputer connection (format 2))
(host GOT)
Sum
STX Com-
mand
Station No. Address Number of ETX
bytes Check
A 1 5 2 0 0 0 0 4 D 0 4
02H 41H 31H 35H 32H 30H 30H 30H 30H 34H 03H 44H 30H
(H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
Sum check is performed in this range.
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
00000001000000000000000010000000
MMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMM
Response message
76543210111111982222111133222222
543210 3210987610987654 6
during normal
CONNECTION TO
(format 15: GOT-F900 Series microcomputer connection (format 2))
SOUND OUTPUT
communication
(GOT host) Sum check is performed in this range.
0 1 0 0 0 0 8 0 8 C
02H 30H 31H 30H 30H 30H 30H 38H 30H 03H 38H 43H 7
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
00000001000000000000000010000000
DEVICE
MMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMM
76543210111111982222111133222222
543210 3210987610987654
8
Response message NAK
DEVICE CONNECTION
during faulty
AUTHENTICATION
communication
FINGERPRINT
15H
(GOT host)
Number of
STX Com-
mand Station No. Address bytes CR
*1
B 1 5 0 0 C 8 0 4 Following
02H 42H 31H 35H 30H 30H 43H 38H 30H 34H 0DH
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
Number Sum
STX Com- Station No. Address of bytes ETX
mand Check
Request message
(host GOT) B 1 5 0 0 C 8 0 4 Following*1 9 1
02H 42H 31H 35H 30H 30H 43H 38H 30H 34H 03H 39H 31H
(H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
*1
Data 1 Data 2 Data 3 Data 4
(R100 upper) (R100 lower) (R101 upper) (R101 lower)
0 0 6 4 0 0 6 5
30H 30H 36H 34H 30H 30H 36H 35H
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
M15 to 0 0000H M15 to 0 0001H
MICROCOMPUTER
Item Message format
CONNECTION
(format 14: GOT-F900 Series microcomputer connection (format 1))
(SERIAL)
Com- Number of
STX mand Station No. Address bytes CR
3
*1
B 1 5 2 0 0 0 0 4 Following
02H 42H 31H 35H 32H 30H 30H 30H 30H 34H 0DH
(H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L)
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
(format 15: GOT-F900 Series microcomputer connection (format 2))
Byte Sum
STX Com-
mand
Station No. Address ETX
Number Check
4
B 1 5 2 0 0 0 0 4 Following*1 5 A
02H 42H 31H 35H 32H 30H 30H 30H 30H 34H 03H 35H 41H
Request message (H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
(host GOT)
MODBUS(R)/RTU
Sum check is performed in this range.
CONNECTION
*1
Data 1 Data 2 Data 3 Data 4
(M7 to 0) (M15 to 8) (M23 to 16) (M31 to 24)
0
30H
1
31H
0
30H
0
30H
0
30H
0
30H
8
38H
0
30H
5
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
00000001000000000000000010000000
MMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMM
76543210111111982222111133222222
543210 3210987610987654
6
Response message ACK
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
during normal
communication
(GOT host) 06H UNIT
Response message
during faulty
NAK
7
communication
CONNECTION TO
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
Com- Number of
STX mand Station No. points CR
D 3 1 0 2 Following*1
02H 44H 33H 31H 30H 32H 0DH
(H) (L) (H) (L)
1 2 0 0 3 8 0 0 2 0 F E 4 0
31H 32H 30H 30H 33H 38H 30H 30H 32H 30H 46 45H 34H 30H
(H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L)
*2 *2
(write specification1=1) (write specification2=0)
Source data 10101010 Source data 10101010
bit pattern 10000000 bit pattern 01000000
PROCEDURES FOR
Write
Function Description Action example
PREPARATORY
specification
MONITORING
Original data 1010
ON
0 Bits set to "1" by the bit pattern are turned ON. Bit pattern 1100
specification
Result 1110
MICROCOMPUTER
specification
Result 0010
CONNECTION
Original data 1010
(SERIAL)
Invert
2 Bits set to "1" by the bit pattern are inverted. Bit pattern 1100
specification
Result 0110
MICROCOMPUTER
specification directly.
Result 1100
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
4
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
5
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
6
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
0000H 1616H
Request message
(format 15: GOT-F900 Series microcomputer connection (format 2))
(host GOT)
Write Sum
STX Com-
mand Station No. Start address End address Data ETX Check
E 2 7 0 0 6 4 0 0 C 9 1 6 B E
02H 45H 32H 37H 30H 30H 36H 34H 30H 30H 43H 39H 31H 36H 03H 42H 45H
(H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
POINT
(1) Start address/end address specification conditions
Specify addresses so that the start address is the same or less than the end address.
Error response occurs in the following cases:
• The address to specify has the start address greater than the end address.
• Either of the start address or end address exceeds the device range that can be specified.
PROCEDURES FOR
The following shows an example of reading the clock data of GOT at station No.27.
(Assuming that the clock data of GOT has been set to "2004, June 1, 18:46:49, Tuesday".)
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
Time display
2004/06/01 18:46:49 TUE
MICROCOMPUTER
Item Message format
CONNECTION
(format 14: GOT-F900 Series microcomputer connection (format 1))
(SERIAL)
Com-
STX mand Station No. CR
G 2 7
02H 47H 32H 37H 0DH 3
(H) (L)
MICROCOMPUTER
Request message (format 15: GOT-F900 Series microcomputer connection (format 2))
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
(host GOT)
Sum
STX Com-
mand Station No. ETX Check
G 2 7 B 3
02H 47H 32H
(H)
37H
(L)
03H 42H
(H)
33H
(L)
4
MODBUS(R)/RTU
Sum check is performed in this range.
CONNECTION
(format 14: GOT-F900 Series microcomputer connection (format 1))
Day-of-
STX Year data Month data Day data Hour data Minute data Second data week data CR
02H
0
30H
4
34H
0
30H
6
36H
0
30H
1
31H
1
31H
8
38H
4
34H
6
36H
4
34H
9
39H
0
30H
2
32H 0DH
5
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
MODBUS(R)/TCP
Response message
CONNECTION
during normal (format 15: GOT-F900 Series microcomputer connection (format 2))
communication
(GOT host) Day-of- Sum
STX Year data Month data Day data Hour data Minute data Second data week data ETX Check
0 4 0 6 0 1 1 8 4 6 4 9 0 2 D 0
02H 30H 34H 30H 36H 30H 31H 31H 38H 34H 36H 34H 39H 30H 32H 03H 44H 30H 6
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
Sum check is performed in this range.
during faulty
communication
(GOT host) 15H 7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
Time display
2004/06/01 18:46:49 TUE
After execution
Second Day-of-
STX Com- Station No. Year data Month data Day Data Hour data Minute data CR
mand data week data
F 2 7 0 4 0 6 0 1 1 8 4 6 4 9 0 2
02H 46H 32H 37H 30H 34H 30H 36H 30H 31H 31H 38H 34H 36H 34H 39H 30H 32H 0DH
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
Sum
STX Com-
mand
Station No. ETX Check
Request message
F 2 7 Following*1 7 F
(host GOT)
02H 46H 32H 37H 03H 37H 46H
(H) (L) (H) (L)
*1
Second Day-of-
Year data Month data Day data Hour data Minute data
data week data
0 4 0 6 0 1 1 8 4 6 4 9 0 2
30H 34H 30H 36H 30H 31H 31H 38H 34H 36H 34H 39H 30H 32H
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
POINT
When a wrong day of the week has been set by the clock data setting command
If a wrong day of the week is set by the clock data setting commands, the clock data will differ from the time
displayed on the utility.
Example: When June 1, 2004 (Thursday) is set by the clock data setting command(the actual day of week is
Tuesday),
Tuesday (TUE) will be displayed on the utility time display.
PROCEDURES FOR
The following shows an example of an interrupt output when data are written to the interrupt output devices (D13
and D14).
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
(Assuming that "3139H" is written to D13 and "AA55H" to D14.)
D13 3139H
2
MICROCOMPUTER
Interrupt
CONNECTION
(SERIAL)
Interrupt output
Output Output
value 1 value 2
3
31H 39H
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
Item Message format
(1) When [Interrupt Data Byte] in "Communication Detail Settings" is set to "1 byte"
Output
value 1 4
MODBUS(R)/RTU
39H
CONNECTION
(2) When [Interrupt Data Byte] in "Communication Detail Settings" is set to "2 byte"
Output Output
Interrupt output
(GOT host)
value 1 value 2
5
31H 39H
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
(3) When [Interrupt Data Byte] in "Communication Detail Settings" is set to "4 byte"
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
POINT UNIT
Interrupt output
• To disable the interrupt output, turn ON SM52 (interrupt code output disable flag). ( 2.4.6 SM devices) 7
• To enable the interrupt output, set 8 bits to the data length at "Communication Detail Settings".
CONNECTION TO
• When "7 bits" is set, the MSB (8th bit) is ignored.(Example: FFH 7FH)
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
Precautions
(1) Batch reading/writing crossing over different devices
When using the batch read (0, A) or batch write (1, B) command, do not batch read/write crossing over different
devices.
This will cause an error response.
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
2.6.1 Setting communication
interface (Communication Extension setting for microcomputer
settings) Set the GOT interface connecting to the n+1th GOT.
No setting is required for a terminal GOT.
2
Controller setting
POINT
MICROCOMPUTER
Set the channel of the equipment to be connected to the
CONNECTION
GOT.
Microcomputer connection extension
(SERIAL)
The setting is required when connecting multiple GOTs
2. for one microcomputer.
3
2. 3.
MICROCOMPUTER
3.
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
4. Click!
4
MODBUS(R)/RTU
1. Select [Common] [Peripheral Setting]
CONNECTION
[GOT(Extended Computer)] from the menu.
Click!
2. Set the interface to which the n+1th GOT is
connected.
MODBUS(R)/TCP
menu. communication driver.
CONNECTION
2. The Controller Setting window is displayed. Select the
channel to be used from the list menu.
SOUND OUTPUT
• I/F: Interface to be used
This CH No. is used for the
• Driver:Computer
connection with a
Connection CH No. 1 fixed
4. The detailed setting is displayed after Manufacturer,
microcomputer or n-1th GOT.
UNIT
(Default: 1)
Controller Type, I/F, and Driver are set.
Make the settings according to the usage
environment.
Click the [OK] button when settings are completed. 7
2.6.2 Communication detail settings
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
POINT
8
The settings of connecting equipment can be set and
DEVICE CONNECTION
Special
Interrupt Code Event type
(Hex)
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
The following shows a system configuration example in the
case of the microcomputer connection (serial). (2) Monitor screen settings
The following shows the monitor screen settings in this
System configuration system configuration example.
The system configuration example illustrated below is
explained in this section.
(a) Common settings 2
Set D20 to the screen switching device (base
screen).
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(SERIAL)
1. Select [Common] [GOT Environmental Setting]
3
[Screen Switching/Window] to display [Environment
MICROCOMPUTER
IBM-PC/AT-compatible PC
(Microsoft® Visual C++® Ver.6.0) Setup] on GT Designer3.
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
Communication settings on GOT side and
monitor screen settings
(1) Transmission settings 4
Set the transmission settings of the GOT.
The transmission settings in the microcomputer
2.
MODBUS(R)/RTU
connection (serial) are made at [Detail Setting] on GT Set D20 to the screen switching device (base screen).
CONNECTION
Designer3.
2.6.2 Communication detail settings
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
Stop bit 1bit
Parity Even
Format 1
6
Special Interrupt Code None
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
Control Method None
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
No. Device/Style
Base screen 1
Device Data Type Format Number Size Digits
Touch switch
123
Basic Settings
Action
No.
Screen 2 Action Next Screen Device
Data Setting Action
Type Value Type
Signed Constant
1. Numerical display Word ― D13
BIN16 1
―
No. Device/Style
Base screen 2 Lamp Type Device Shape Shape Attribute
Sample Screen 2
Screen 1
3. Bit lamp
The device status of D22.b0 is displayed as a lamp.
4. Switch 2
This is an alternate switch for changing the state of
D22.b0.
5. Switch 3
This is the screen switching switch to [Sample
Screen 1]. Touching this changes the base screen
to [Sample Screen 1].
PROCEDURES FOR
The following describes the processing on the host Number of Sum
PREPARATORY
STX Command Address Data 1 (D20) ETX
side, display/processing on the GOT side, and data points Check
MONITORING
transfer packets. 02H
W
57H
D
44H 30H
0 0
30H
2
32H
0
30H
0
30H
1
31H
0
30H
0
30H
0
30H
1
31H 03H
8
38H
2
32H
(Assuming that host side programs use programs (H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L)
which perform the processing on host side shown
Sum check is performed in this range.
below.)
Packet Display/
*2 Displays the send packet structure of the numerical value display
batch write packet.
2
Processing Processing on host side used for Processing on
MICROCOMPUTER
data transfer GOT side Number of
STX Command Address Data 1 (D21) ETX Sum check
points
Opens the port. ―― ――
CONNECTION
(Changes
W D 0 0 2 1 0 1
Screen 1 (any value) according to
02 H 57H 44H 30H 30H 32H 31H 30H 31H 03H data section.)
batch
(SERIAL)
Writes "1" to the screen switching Displays base (H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L)
switching device (D20). Write screen 1. Sum check is performed in this range.
packet*1 *3 Displays the send packet structure of the numerical value display
Initial
Receives a response from
the GOT.
―― ―― batch read packet. 3
processing Judges whether or not Number of Sum
MICROCOMPUTER
STX Command Address ETX
points Check
there is an error in the ―― ――
R D 0 0 2 1 0 1 B D
response from the GOT.
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
02H 52H 44H 30H 30H 32H 31H 30H 31H 03H 42H 44H
Batch Displays "0" on (H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
numerical the numerical
Writes an initial value to value Sum check is performed in this range.
value display
device (D21). display write on base screen *4 Displays the receive packet structure of the batch write response
packet*2 1.
packet.
When Issues the
Batch When normally operated When an error occurred
4
receiving a current
response to value numerical ACK NAK
value
MODBUS(R)/RTU
writing to acquisition
device (D21) request to display read
CONNECTION
06H 15H
from the device packet*3 Increments the
GOT (D21). numerical value
Creates the displayed on *5 Displays the receive packet structure of the batch read response
next device ―― base screen 1. packet.
value (D21). (The host side
When
receiving a
Calculates
the sum
repeats the
processing on
When normally operated
NAK
5
response to ―― the left as long
check of the (Changes
reading of as base screen (any data)
send packet. according to
MODBUS(R)/TCP
02H 03H data section.) 15H
device (D21) 1 is displayed.))
CONNECTION
from the Issues the Batch (H) – – (L) (H) (L)
from 2 to 1
EXTERNAL I/O
End
processing
DEVICE
(only when
Close the port. ―― ――
receiving an
error
response)
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
Setting item
Item Description
Information Displays the device type and setting range which are selected in [Device].
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
GOT clock control
MONITORING
The settings of "time adjusting" or "time broadcast"
made on the GOT will be disabled on the PLC. Use the
dedicated commands to set or read out the clock data
of microcomputer. 2
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(SERIAL)
3
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
4
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
5
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
6
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
2
MICROCOMPUTER
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(SERIAL)
3.
CONNECTION (ETHERNET) 3
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
4
3.1 Microcomputer connection (Ethernet) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 2
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
3.2 System Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 2
3.3 Device Data Area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 3
3.4 Message Formats. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 16
5
3.5 GOT Side Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 69
MODBUS(R)/TCP
3.6 System Configuration Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 72
CONNECTION
3.7 Device Range that Can Be Set . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 73
3.8 Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3 - 74
6
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
3-1
3. MICROCOMPUTER CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
For the flow of the data processing, such as reading or writing data and interrupt output, refer to the following.
2.1 Microcomputer Connection (Serial)
Ethernet (microcomputer)
Host GOT
Connection cable
• 10BASE-T
Shielded twisted pair cable (STP) or
unshielded twisted pair cable (UTP): Unlimited number
Ethernet 100m
Category 3, 4, and 5 of GOTs for 1 host
GT15-J71E71-100
• 100BASE-TX
Shielded twisted pair cable (STP):
Category 5 and 5e
*1 The destination connected with the twisted pair cable varies with the configuration of the applicable Ethernet network system.
Connect to the Ethernet module, hub, transceiver or other system equipment corresponding to the applicable Ethernet network
system.
Use cables, connectors, and hubs that meet the IEEE802.3 10BASE-T/100BASE-TX standard.
*2 A length between a hub and a node.
The maximum distance differs depending on the Ethernet device to be used.
The following shows the number of the connectable nodes when a repeater hub is used.
• 10BASE-T: Max. 4 nodes for a cascade connection (500m)
• 100BASE-TX: Max. 2 nodes for a cascade connection (205m)
When switching hubs are used, the cascade connection between the switching hubs has no logical limit for the number of
cascades.
For the limit, contact the switching hub manufacturer.
*3 When connecting GT16 of the function version A to an equipment that meets the 10BASE (-T/2/5) standard, use the switching
hub and operate in a 10Mbps/100Mbps mixed environment.
For how to check the function version, refer to the following.
GT16 User’s Manual (Hardware)
*4 GT14 models compatible with Ethernet connection are only GT1455-QTBDE, GT1450-QMBDE and GT1450-QLBDE.
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
The following shows a list of virtual devices inside the GOT available in the microcomputer connection (Ethernet), and
the address specification values for each data format.
The address specification of the virtual devices differs depending on the data format.*1
Virtual device*2
2
Address specification value
Device Refer to
Format Format Format Format
Name range Device type
MICROCOMPUTER
1, 2 3, 4 5 6 to 9
(decimal)
CONNECTION
D 0 to 4095 Word 0 to 4095 8000 to 9FFFH 0000 to 0FFFH D0 to 4095 3.3.1
(SERIAL)
R 0 to 4095 Word 4096 to 8191 0000 to 1FFFH 1000 to 1FFFH R0 to 4095 3.3.2
L 0 to 2047 Bit 8192 to 8319 A000 to A0FFH 2000 to 207FH L0 to 2047 3.3.3
M 0 to 2047 Bit 8320 to 8447 2000 to 20FFH 2080 to 20FFH M0 to 2047
2100 to 211FH
3.3.4
3
SD 0 to 15 Word 8448 to 8463 *3
2100 to 210FH SD0 to 15 3.3.5
(3000 to 300DH)
MICROCOMPUTER
SM 0 to 63 Bit 8464 to 8467 2200 to 2207H 2110 to 2113H SM0 to 63 3.3.6
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
*1 For the address specification method for each data format, refer to the following.
MODBUS(R)/RTU
*2 When reusing GOT900 Series project data
CONNECTION
• GOT-A900 Series virtual devices (D0 to 2047)
Can be used as they are without changing the assignments.
• GOT-F900 Series virtual devices
Since some of the assigned virtual device values differ as indicated below, change the assignment using device batch edit of
GT Designer3.
Refer to the following manual for device batch edit of GT Designer3. 5
GT Designer3 Version1 Screen Design Manual
MODBUS(R)/TCP
GOT1000 Series virtual devices GOT-F900 Series virtual devices
CONNECTION
D0 to 2047 ―
D2048 to 4095 ―
R0 to 4095 D0 to 4095
L0 to 2047 ―
M0 to 2047 M0 to 2047 6
D8000 to 8015
SD0 to 15
GD0 to 6
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
SM0 to 63 M8000 to 8063
*3 Access to SD3 to 9 can also be made by the specification of the addresses (3000 to 300DH) of GD0 to 6 on the GOT-F900 Series.
UNIT
POINT
7
Values of virtual devices inside the GOT
When the GOT is turned OFF or reset, values are cleared to their defaults
CONNECTION TO
Values are held in the memory when project data are written to the GOT.
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
The D devices are word devices into which GOT communication errors, clock data or other information are stored.
The user can also store data using the user area.
List of D devices
The following lists the D devices (virtual devices inside the GOT).
D0 to 2 Unused ―
0: Normal
1: Error
b15 – b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 – b0
Unused
D3 SIO framing error
SIO parity error
SIO overrun error
Communication timeout
error
Unused
• b4 to 6 turn ON when an SIO error occurs, and turn OFF when an request message from the host is received
successfully after the error occurrence.
• b7 turns ON about 3 seconds after the host side DTR becomes OFF, and turns OFF when transmission is
performed successfully to the host after the error occurrence.
b15 – b8 b7 – b0
System
D4
b15 – b8 b7 – b0
D5
Data of months 01 to
12 stored as 2-digit BCD
Unused
b15 – b8 b7 – b0
D6
Data of days 01 to
31 stored as 2-digit BCD
Unused
PROCEDURES FOR
Address Description Set side
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
Clock data (hour)
b15 – b8 b7 – b0
D7
Data of hours 00 to
2
23 stored as 2-digit BCD
MICROCOMPUTER
Unused
CONNECTION
Clock data (minute)
(SERIAL)
b15 – b8 b7 – b0
D8 3
MICROCOMPUTER
Data of minutes 00 to
59 stored as 2-digit BCD
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
Unused
MODBUS(R)/RTU
Data of seconds 00 to
CONNECTION
59 stored as 2-digit BCD
Unused
b15 – b8 b7 – b0 5
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
Day-of-week data stored as
D10
2-digit BCD
00: Sunday 01: Monday
02: Tuesday 03: Wednesday
04: Thursday 05: Friday
06: Saturday
Unused
6
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
D11, D12 Unused ―
utility.
Example: When October 1, 2009 (Tuesday) is set by the clock data setting command (the actual day of the week is Thursday),
"02" is stored to D10 although Thursday (THU) will be displayed on the utility time display. 7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
Interrupt output
When data are written to D13 and D14 from a GOT touch switch, for example, the data of D13 and D14 are
transmitted (interrupt output) to the host side.*1*2
The data amount (number of bytes) to be interrupt-output is set at "Interrupt Data Byte" in "Communication Detail
Settings".
( 3.5.1 Setting communication interface (Communication settings))
D13
• Output value when 1 is set to "Interrupt Data Byte" in "Communication Detail Settings"
D13
Lower 8 bits
1 byte
• Output value when 2 is set to "Interrupt Data Byte" in "Communication Detail Settings"
D13
User
Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits
2 bytes
• Output value when 4 is set to "Interrupt Data Byte" in "Communication Detail Settings
(1) When setting the LH order to [32bit Storage] for the communication detail settings
D14 D13
D14
Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits
4 bytes
(2) When setting the HL order to [32bit Storage] for the communication detail settings
D13 D14
4 bytes
D15 to 19 Unused ―
POINT
(1) The side where virtual devices are set
System : Set on the system side.
User : Set on the user side (by sending request messages from host or using the touch switches, etc.
on the GOT).
(2) Interrupt output (D13, D14)
• To disable the interrupt output, turn ON SM52 (interrupt code output disable flag). ( 3.3.6 SM devices)
• To enable the interrupt output, set 8 bits to the data length at "Communication Detail Settings".
( 3.5.1 Setting communication interface (Communication settings))
• When "7 bits" is set, the MSB (8th bit) is ignored. (Example: FFH 7FH)
PROCEDURES FOR
The address specification of devices varies depending on the data format.*1
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
The following shows the address specification values for each data format.
MICROCOMPUTER
D0 0 0000H D0
CONNECTION
8001H Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits
(SERIAL)
8002H 8002H 8003H
D1 1 0001H D1
8003H Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits
: : : : :
3
MICROCOMPUTER
9FFEH 9FFEH 9FFFH
CONNECTION
D4095 4095 0FFFH D4095
(ETHERNET)
9FFFH Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits
*1 For the address specification method for each data format, refer to the following.
MODBUS(R)/RTU
• Formats 6, 7 : 4E frame
CONNECTION
• Formats 8, 9 : QnA compatible 3E frame
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
6
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
The R devices are word devices into which user data are stored.
All of these devices can be used as a user area.
: : : : :
*1 For the address specification method for each data format, refer to the following.
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
The L devices are bit devices into which user data are stored.
MONITORING
All of these devices can be used as a user area.
MICROCOMPUTER
Address Address specification value
CONNECTION
Format Format Format Format
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
1, 2 3, 4 5 6 to 9
(SERIAL)
L7 L6 L5 L4 L3 L2 L1 L0 A000H
8192 2000H
L15 L14 L13 L12 L11 L10 L9 L8 A001H
L23 L22 L21 L20 L19 L18 L17 L16 A002H Same as 3
8193 2001H address
L31 L30 L29 L28 L27 L26 L25 L24 A003H
MICROCOMPUTER
column on
: : : : left*2
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
L2039 L2038 L2037 L2036 L2035 L2034 L2033 L2032 A0FEH
8319 207FH
L2047 L2046 L2045 L2044 L2043 L2042 L2041 L2040 A0FFH
*1 For the address specification method for each data format, refer to the following.
MODBUS(R)/RTU
• Formats 5 : Digital Electronics Corporation's memory link method
CONNECTION
• Formats 6, 7 : 4E frame
• Formats 8, 9 : QnA compatible 3E frame
*2 For reading or writing data in word units, specify the addresses in 16-point units. (Example: L0, L16, L32, etc.)
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
6
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
The M devices are bit devices into which user data are stored.
All of these devices can be used as a user area.
M7 M6 M5 M4 M3 M2 M1 M0 2000H
8320 2080H
M15 M14 M13 M12 M11 M10 M9 M8 2001H
M23 M22 M21 M20 M19 M18 M17 M16 2002H Same as
8321 2081H address
M31 M30 M29 M28 M27 M26 M25 M24 2003H
column on
: : : : left*2
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
The SD devices are word devices into which GOT communication errors (error codes), clock data and other information
MONITORING
are stored.
List of SD devices
The following lists the SD devices (virtual devices inside the GOT).
2
Address Description Set side
MICROCOMPUTER
100ms counter (32bits)
The counter is incremented at 100ms intervals after GOT is turned ON.
CONNECTION
(The time elapsed after GOT is turned ON is stored in 100ms units.)
(SERIAL)
(1) When setting the LH order to [32bit Storage] for the communication detail settings
The lower and upper bits are stored in SD0 and SD1 respectively.
SD0
SD1 SD0
3
SD1 Upper word Lower word
MICROCOMPUTER
(2) When setting the HL order to [32bit Storage] for the communication detail settings
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
The upper and lower bits are stored in SD0 and SD1 respectively.
SD0 SD1
MODBUS(R)/RTU
•Host Address (Communication error that occurred on the request destination GOT)
CONNECTION
0: No error
1: Parity error
2: Framing error
3: Overrun error
System
4: Communication message error
5: Command error 5
SD2*1 6: Clock data setting error
MODBUS(R)/TCP
•Other station (Communication error that occurred on another GOT when multiple GOTs are connected)
CONNECTION
101: Parity error
102: Framing error
103: Overrun error
104: Communication message error
105: Timeout error (No station of the specified address exists.)
106: Multiple units not connectable
107: Clock data setting error
6
Clock data (second)
CONNECTION TO
SD3
SOUND OUTPUT
Second data of 00 to 59 is stored.
SD7
Month data of 01 to 12 is stored.
*1 For details and corrective actions for the errors (error codes) that are stored into SD2, refer to the following:
■ Details and actions for errors (error codes) stored into SD2
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
SD10 to 15 Unused ―
*1 If a wrong day of the week is set by the clock data setting commands, the clock data will differ from the time displayed on the
utility.
Example: When October 1, 2009 (Tuesday) is set by the clock data setting command (the actual day of the week is Thursday),
"2" is stored to SD9 although Thursday (THU) will be displayed on the utility time display.
POINT
The side where virtual devices are set
System : Set on the system side.
User : Set on the user side (by sending request messages from host or using the touch switches, etc.
on the GOT).
Details and actions for errors (error codes) stored into SD2
Error code Description Action
0 No error ―
Overrun error
• Check the settings of "Communication Detail Settings".
3, 103 The next data was transmitted from the host before GOT
• Decrease the transmission speed.
completes the processing of the data received.
PROCEDURES FOR
The address specification of devices varies depending on the data format.*1
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
The following shows the address specification values for each data format.
MICROCOMPUTER
2101H Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits
CONNECTION
2102H 2102H 2103H
(SERIAL)
SD1 8449 2101H SD1
2103H Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits
MICROCOMPUTER
2105H Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
2106H
(3000H) 2106H(3000H) 2107H(3001H)
SD3 8451 2103H SD3
2107H
Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits
(3001H)
2108H 4
(3002H) 2108H(3002H) 2109H(3003H)
SD4 8452 2104H SD4
MODBUS(R)/RTU
2109H
Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits
CONNECTION
(3003H)
210AH
(3004H) 210AH(3004H) 210BH(3005H)
SD5 8453 2105H SD5
210BH
Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits
(3005H)
5
210CH
(3006H) 210CH(3006H) 210DH(3007H)
MODBUS(R)/TCP
SD6 8454 2106H SD6
210DH
CONNECTION
Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits
(3007H)
210EH
(3008H) 210EH(3008H) 210FH(3009H)
SD7 8455 2107H SD7
210FH
(3009H)
Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits 6
2110H
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
(300AH) 2110H(300AH) 2111H(300BH)
SD8 8456 2108H SD8
2111H
Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits
(300BH) UNIT
2112H
(300CH) 2112H(300CH) 2113H(300DH)
SD9 8457
2113H
Upper 8 bits Lower 8 bits
2109H SD9
7
(300DH)
CONNECTION TO
*1 For the address specification method for each data format, refer to the following.
EXTERNAL I/O
Series.
FINGERPRINT
The SM devices are bit devices into which interrupt outputs and clock data that turn ON/OFF at 1-second cycles.
List of SM devices
The following shows the SM devices (virtual devices inside the GOT).
Interrupt output
When the ON/OFF state of SM0 to 49 is changed by a touch switch on the GOT, for example, the interrupt
codes shown below are transmitted (interrupt output) to the host side.*1*2
The data amount (number of bytes) to be interrupt-output is set at "Interrupt Data Byte" in "Communication
Detail Settings". ( 3.5.1 Setting communication interface (Communication settings))
System
2-second cycle clock
Turns ON/OFF at a 2-second cycle.
SM51
1 1
SM53 to 63 Unused ―
*1 After the ON/OFF state is changed, the interrupt data is output within a period of 1 to 10 ms.
*2 When the ON/OFF state of SM0 to 49 is changed from the host side, interrupt output is not performed.
POINT
(1) The side where virtual devices are set
System : Set on the system side.
User : Set on the user side (by sending request messages from host or using the touch switches, etc.
on the GOT).
(2) Interrupt outputs (SM0 to 49)
• To disable the interrupt output, turn ON SM52 (interrupt code output disable flag). ( 3.3.6 SM devices)
• To enable the interrupt output, set 8 bits to the data length at "Communication Detail Settings".
( 3.5.1 Setting communication interface (Communication settings))
• When "7 bits" is set, the MSB (8th bit) is ignored. (Example: FFH 7FH)
PROCEDURES FOR
The address specification of devices varies depending on the data format.*1
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
The following shows the address specification values for each data format.
MICROCOMPUTER
8464 2110H
SM15 SM14 SM13 SM12 SM11 SM10 SM9 SM8 2201H
CONNECTION
SM23 SM22 SM21 SM20 SM19 SM18 SM17 SM16 2202H
8465 2111H
(SERIAL)
SM31 SM30 SM29 SM28 SM27 SM26 SM25 SM24 2203H
*2*3
SM39 SM38 SM37 SM36 SM35 SM34 SM33 SM32 2204H
8466 2112H
SM47 SM46 SM45 SM44 SM43 SM42 SM41 SM40 2205H
3
Unused SM52 SM51 SM50 SM49 SM48 8467 2206H
2113H
MICROCOMPUTER
Unused ― ―
CONNECTION
*1 For the address specification method for each data format, refer to the following.
(ETHERNET)
3.4 Message Formats
• Formats 1, 2 : GOT-A900 Series microcomputer connection
• Formats 3, 4 : GOT-F900 series microcomputer connection
•
•
Formats 5
Formats 6, 7
:
:
Digital Electronics Corporation's memory link method
4E frame
4
• Formats 8, 9 : QnA compatible 3E frame
MODBUS(R)/RTU
*2 In formats 6, 7, values are specified within a range of SM0 to 52.
CONNECTION
*3 For reading or writing data in word units, specify the addresses in 16-point units. (Example: SM0, SM16, SM32, etc.)
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
6
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
GOT-A900 series microcomputer connection This format is used when the GOT is connected to the host in a 1:1
Format 1
(ASCII) connection. The data format is ASCII.
3.4.3
GOT-A900 series microcomputer connection This format is used when the GOT is connected to the host in a 1:1
Format 2
(Binary) connection. The data format is Binary.
GOT-F900 series microcomputer connection This format is used when the GOT is connected to the host in a 1:1
Format 3
(ASCII) connection. The data format is ASCII.
3.4.4
GOT-F900 series microcomputer connection This format is used when the GOT is connected to the host in a 1:1
Format 4
(Binary) connection. The data format is Binary.
Digital Electronics Corporation's memory link This is the basic format of the Digital Electronics Corporation's memory link
Format 5 3.4.5
method method.
Format 6 4E frame (ASCII) This is the basic format of the MC protocols. The data format is ASCII.
3.4.6
Format 7 4E frame (Binary) This is the basic format of the MC protocols. The data format is Binary.
Format 8 QnA compatible 3E frame (ASCII) This is the basic format of the MC protocols. The data format is ASCII.
3.4.7
Format 9 QnA compatible 3E frame (Binary) This is the basic format of the MC protocols. The data format is Binary.
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
The following shows the list of commands available in each data format.
MONITORING
List of commands for formats 1, 2 (GOT-A900 Series microcomputer connection)
Command
Symbol
ASCII Command name Description
Max. number of points
processed 2
code
MICROCOMPUTER
Batch read Reads bit devices in 16-point units. 64 words (1024 points)
RD 52H 44H
CONNECTION
in word units Reads word devices in 1-point units. 64 points
(SERIAL)
Batch write Writes to bit devices in 16-point units. 64 words (1024 points)
WD 57H 44H
in word units Writes to word devices in 1-point units. 64 points
RR 52H 52H
Random read Reads multiple different bit devices in 16-point units. 64 words (1024 points)
3
in word units*1 Reads multiple different word devices in 1-point units. 64 points
MICROCOMPUTER
Random write Writes to multiple different word devices in 16-point units. 64 words (1024 points)
RW 52H 57H
CONNECTION
in word units*1
(ETHERNET)
Writes to multiple different word devices in 1-point units. 64 points
TR 54H 52H Read clock data Reads the clock data of the GOT. ―
TS 54H 53H Set clock data Sets the clock data of the GOT. ―
*1 Mixed specification of bit devices and word devices is also possible.
4
List of commands for formats 3, 4 (GOT-F900 series microcomputer connection)
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
Command
Max. number of points
ASCII Command name Description
Symbol processed
code
0 30H
Batch read
(w/out station No.)
Reads bit devices in byte units. 255bytes (2040 points)
5
Reads word devices in byte units. 255bytes (127 points)
MODBUS(R)/TCP
Batch read
A 41H
CONNECTION
(w/ station No.) Reads word devices in byte units. 255bytes (127 points)
Batch write Writes to bit devices in byte units. 255bytes (2040 points)
1 31H
(w/out station No.) Writes to word devices in byte units. 255bytes (127 points)
B 42H
Batch write
(w/ station No.)
Writes to bit devices in byte units. 255bytes (2040 points)
6
Writes to word devices in byte units. 255bytes (127 points)
CONNECTION TO
Multi-point write in bit
SOUND OUTPUT
3 33H
units (w/out station No.) Writes bit patterns (bit ON/OFF, inversion, direct specification) in
70bytes (560 points)
Multi-point write in bit 1-point units (8 bits for 1 point) to a specified device.
D 44H
units (w/ station No.)
UNIT
Fill command
4 34H
(w/out station No.)
Fill command
Writes the same value to a range of specified devices. ― 7
E 45H
(w/ station No.)
CONNECTION TO
5 35H
(w/out station No.)
Sets the clock data of the GOT. ―
DEVICE
Batch read Reads bit devices in 16-point units. 64 words (1024 points)
R 52H
in word units Reads word devices in 1-point units. 64 points
Batch write Writes to bit devices in 16-point units. 64 words (1024 points)
W 57H
in word units Writes to word devices in 1-point units. 64 points
List of commands for formats 6, 7 (4E frame), formats 8, 9 (QnA compatible 3E frame)
Sub- Max. number of points
Command Command name Description
command processed
Batch read
0401 0001 Reads bit devices in 1-point units. 64 points
in bit units
Batch read Reads bit devices in 16-point units.*3 64 words (1024 points)
0401 0000
in word units Reads word devices in 1-point units. 64 points
Batch write
1401 0001 Writes to bit devices in 1-point units. 64 points
in bit units
Batch write Writes to bit devices in 16-point units.*3 64 words (1024 points)
1401 0000
in word units Writes to word devices in 1-point units. 64 points
Random read Reads multiple different bit devices in 16-point and 32-point units.*3 64 words (1024 points)
0403 0000
in word units*1 Reads multiple different word devices in 1-point and 2-point units. 64 points
Random write
1402 0001 Writes to multiple different bit devices in 1-point units. 64 points
in bit units
Random write Writes to multiple different bit devices in 16-point and 32-point units.*3 64 words (1024 points)
1402 0000 *1
in word units Writes to multiple different word devices in 1-point and 2-point units. 64 points
Multiple block Reads multiple blocks. A bit device (16 bits for 1 point) or a word device
0406 0000 64 points
batch read (1 word for 1 point) is regarded as one block.*3
Multiple block Writes multiple blocks. A bit device (16 bits for 1 point) or a word device
1406 0000 64 points
batch write (1 word for 1 point) is regarded as one block.*3
1901*2 0000 Read clock data Reads the clock data of the GOT. ―
*2 0000 Set clock data Sets the clock data of the GOT. ―
0901
*1 Mixed specification of bit devices and word devices is also possible.
*2 This is a dedicated command of GOT for the microcomputer connection.
*3 Specifies the address of bit devices in 16-point units. (Example: M0, M16, M32, and others)
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
2
Basic format of data communication
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
Item Message format
(SERIAL)
Command Data
Request message
(host GOT)
3
(H) (L)
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(1) During processing of read commands
(ETHERNET)
Data
4
Response message
during normal
MODBUS(R)/RTU
communication
CONNECTION
(2) During processing of write commands
(GOT host)
ACK
06H 5
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
Error
Response message NAK Code
during faulty
communication
(GOT host) 15H
6
Output value
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
During interrupt
output 1/2/4
bytes*1 UNIT
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
POINT
Data code during communication
Communication of the format 1 is performed in ASCII code. (excluding interrupt output)
Communication of the format 2 is performed in Binary code.
(2) Command
Specifies the contents to access from the host to GOT.
The command is converted to a 2-digit ASCII code (Hex) and transmitted from the upper digit.
For details of the commands that can be used, refer to the following.
3.4.2 List of commands
(3) Address
Specifies the head No. of the device data to be read/written.
In the format 1, the address notated in decimal is converted to a 4-digit ASCII code (Hex) and transmitted from
the upper digit.
In the format 2, the address notated in decimal is converted to a 2-digit Binary code (binary) and transmitted
from the upper digit.
For details of the device range that can be accessed, refer to the following.
3.3 Device Data Area
(6) Data
Specifies the data to read from/write to the specified device data.(word unit)
In the format 1, the address notated in hexadecimal is converted to a 4-digit ASCII code (Hex) and transmitted
from the upper digit.
In the format 2, the address notated in hexadecimal is converted to a 2-digit Binary code (binary) and
transmitted from the upper digit.
(7) Error code
This is the response message at faulty communication appended with error contents. Error code is transmitted
in 1 byte.
For the error codes, refer to the following.
■ Error code list
PROCEDURES FOR
(1) Batch read in word units (RD) command
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
(a) When reading a word device
The following shows an example of reading the two points of the virtual devices D100 and D101.
(Assuming D100=0102H, D101=0304H are stored.)
MICROCOMPUTER
D100 0102H
CONNECTION
D101 0304H
(SERIAL)
Item Message format
MICROCOMPUTER
Number of
Command Address points
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
R D 0 1 0 0 0 2
52H 44H 30H 31H 30H 30H 30H 32H
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
Request message
(host GOT)
(format 2: GOT-A900 Series microcomputer connection (Binary)) 4
Number
MODBUS(R)/RTU
Command Address of points
CONNECTION
R D 00H 64H 02H
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
0 1 0 2 0 3 0 4
30H 31H 30H 32H 30H 33H 30H 34H
Response message
(H) (L) (H) (L)
during normal
communication
(format 2: GOT-A900 Series microcomputer connection (Binary))
(GOT host)
Data 1 Data 2 6
(D100) (D101)
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
01H 02H 03H 04H
UNIT
Error
NAK code
Response message 7
during faulty
15H 06H
communication
CONNECTION TO
(GOT host)
EXTERNAL I/O
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
M15 to 0 0001H
M31 to 6 8000H
Number
Command Address of points
0 0 0 1 8 0 0 0
30H 30H 30H 31H 38H 30H 30H 30H
(H) (L) (H) (L)
00000000000000011000000000000000
MMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMM
11111198765432103322222222221111
Response message 543210 1098765432109876
during normal
communication
(format 2: GOT-A900 Series microcomputer connection (Binary))
(GOT host)
Data 1 Data 2
(M15 to 0) (M31 to 16)
00000000000000011000000000000000
MMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMM
11111198765432103322222222221111
543210 1098765432109876
Error
NAK code
Response message
during faulty
15H 06H
communication
(GOT host)
The above is a case where
the sum check error (06H)
has occurred.
PROCEDURES FOR
(a) When writing to a word device
PREPARATORY
The following shows as example of writing "0064H"and "0065H"to virtual devices D100 and D101.
MONITORING
D100 0000H D100 0064H
MICROCOMPUTER
Before execution After execution
CONNECTION
Item Message format
(SERIAL)
(format 1: GOT-A900 Series microcomputer connection (ASCII))
Number of
3
Command Address points Data 1(D100) Data 2 (D101)
W D 0 1 0 0 0 2 0 0 6 4 0 0 6 5
MICROCOMPUTER
57H 44H 30H 31H 30H 30H 30H 32H 30H 30H 36H 34H 30H 30H 36H 35H
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
Request message
(host GOT) (format 2: GOT-A900 Series microcomputer connection (Binary))
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
Response message ACK
during normal
communication
(GOT host)
06H
5
MODBUS(R)/TCP
Error
CONNECTION
NAK code
Response message
during faulty
15H 06H
communication
(GOT host)
The above is a case where
the sum check error (06H)
6
has occurred.
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
Number
Command Address of points Data 1 (M15 to 0) Data 2 (M31 to 16)
W D 8 3 2 0 0 2 0 0 0 1 8 0 0 0
57H 44H 38H 33H 32H 30H 30H 32H 30H 30H 30H 31H 38H 30H 30H 30H
(H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) – – (L)
00000000000000011000000000000000
MMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMM
11111198765432103322222222221111
543210 1098765432109876
Request message
(host GOT) (format 2: GOT-A900 Series microcomputer connection (Binary))
00000000000000011000000000000000
MMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMM
11111198765432103322222222221111
543210 1098765432109876
Error
NAK code
Response message
during faulty
15H 06H
communication
(GOT host)
The above is a case where
the sum check error (06H)
has occurred.
PROCEDURES FOR
The following shows an example of reading the two points of the virtual devices D100 and M0 to M15.
(Assuming D100=0064H, M0=1are stored.)
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
D100 0064H
M15 to 0 0001H
2
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
Item Message format
(SERIAL)
(format 1: GOT-A900 Series microcomputer connection (ASCII))
R R 0 1 0 0 8 3 2 0
3
MICROCOMPUTER
52H 52H 30H 31H 30H 30H 38H 33H 32H 30H
(H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) – – (L)
CONNECTION
Request message
(ETHERNET)
(host GOT) (format 2: GOT-A900 Series microcomputer connection (Binary))
4
R R 00H 64H 20H 80H
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
(format 1: GOT-A900 Series microcomputer connection (ASCII))
0
30H
0
30H
6
36H
4
34H
0
30H
0
30H
0
30H
1
31H
5
(H) – – (L) (H) – – (L)
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
0000000000000001
MMMMMMMMMMMMMMMM
Response message 1111119876543210
543210
during normal
communication (format 2: GOT-A900 Series microcomputer connection (Binary)) 6
(GOT host)
CONNECTION TO
Data 1 Data 2
SOUND OUTPUT
(D100) (M15 to 0)
7
0000000000000001
CONNECTION TO
MMMMMMMMMMMMMMMM
1111119876543210
EXTERNAL I/O
543210
DEVICE
Error
NAK code
Response message
during faulty
15H 06H
8
communication
DEVICE CONNECTION
(GOT host)
AUTHENTICATION
R W 0 1 0 0 0 0 6 4 8 3 2 0 0 0 0 1
52H 57H 30H 31H 30H 30H 30H 30H 36H 34H 38H 33H 32H 30H 30H 30H 30H 31H
(H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) – – (L) (H) – – (L) (H) – – (L)
0000000000000001
MMMMMMMMMMMMMMMM
1111119876543210
543210
Request message
(host GOT) (format 2: GOT-A900 Series microcomputer connection (Binary))
0000000000000001
MMMMMMMMMMMMMMMM
1111119876543210
543210
Error
NAK code
Response message
during faulty
15H 06H
communication
(GOT host)
The above is a case where
the sum check error (06H)
has occurred.
PROCEDURES FOR
The following shows an example of reading the clock data of GOT.
(Assuming that the clock data of GOT has been set to "2009, October 1, 18:46:49, Thursday".)
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
Time display
2009/10/01 18:46:49 THU
2
MICROCOMPUTER
Item Message format
CONNECTION
(SERIAL)
Command
Request message
T R
(host GOT)
54H
(H) (L)
52H
3
MICROCOMPUTER
(format 1: GOT-A900 Series microcomputer connection (ASCII))
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
Second Day-of-
Year data Month data Day data Hour data Minute data data week data
0 9 1 0 0 1 1 8 4 6 4 9 0 4
30H 39H 31H 30H 30H 31H 31H 38H 34H 36H 34H 39H 30H 34H
Response message
during normal
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) 4
communication (format 2: GOT-A900 Series microcomputer connection (Binary))
MODBUS(R)/RTU
(GOT host)
CONNECTION
Year Month Day Hour Minute Second Day-of-
data data data data data data week data
5
Error
MODBUS(R)/TCP
NAK code
CONNECTION
Response message
during faulty
15H 06H
communication
(GOT host)
The above is a case where
the sum check error (06H)
has occurred.
6
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
Time display
2009/10/01 18:46:49 THU
After execution
Second Day-of-
Command Year data Month data Day data Hour data Minute data data week data
T S 0 9 1 0 0 1 1 8 4 6 4 9 0 4
54H 53H 30H 39H 31H 30H 30H 31H 31H 38H 34H 36H 34H 39H 30H 34H
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
Request message
(host GOT) (format 2: GOT-A900 Series microcomputer connection (Binary))
Error
NAK code
Response message
during faulty
15H 06H
communication
(GOT host)
The above is a case where
the sum check error (06H)
has occurred.
POINT
When a wrong day of the week has been set by the clock data setting command
If a wrong day of the week is set by the clock data setting commands, the clock data will differ from the time
displayed on the utility.
Example: When October 1, 2009 (Tuesday) is set by the clock data setting command (the actual day of the week is
Thursday), Thursday (THU) will be displayed on the utility time display.
PROCEDURES FOR
The following shows an example of an interrupt output when data are written to the interrupt output devices (D13
and D14).
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
(Assuming that "3139H" is written to D13 and "AA55H" to D14.)
D13 3139H
2
MICROCOMPUTER
Interrupt
CONNECTION
(SERIAL)
Interrupt output
Output Output
value 1 value 2
3
31H 39H
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
Item Message format
(1) When [Interrupt Data Byte] in "Communication Detail Settings" is set to "1 byte"
Output
value 1 4
MODBUS(R)/RTU
39H
CONNECTION
(2) When [Interrupt Data Byte] in "Communication Detail Settings" is set to "2 byte"
Output Output
Interrupt output
(GOT host)
value 1 value 2
5
31H 39H
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
(3) When [Interrupt Data Byte] in "Communication Detail Settings" is set to "4 byte"
6
AAH 55H 31H 39H
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
POINT UNIT
Interrupt output
To disable the interrupt output, turn ON SM52 (interrupt code output disable flag). 7
( 3.3.6 SM devices)
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
Address error
7AH • Review the contents of the message to transmit.
The start address of the read/write device is out of range.
• Check the devices that can be used and the device ranges.
Exceeded number of points error
7BH ( 3.3 Device Data Area)
The read/write range exceeded the device range.
Precautions
(1) Batch reading/writing crossing over different devices
When using the batch read (RD) or batch write (WD) command, do not batch read/write crossing over the
different devices.
This will cause an error response.
(2) Storage order for 32-bit data
To use the program of GOT-A900 series with [32bit Order] setting to GOT1000 series, set [HL Order] to [32bit
Order] for [Communication Detail Settings] when 32-bit data is set for GOT-A900 series.
With setting [LH Order], the order of upper bits and lower bits are reversed when the GOT displays and writes
32-bit data.
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
2
Basic format of data communication
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
Item Message format
(SERIAL)
(1) w/out station No.
Com- Data
mand
3
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
Request message
(host GOT) (2) w/station No.
MODBUS(R)/RTU
(H) (L)
CONNECTION
(1) During processing of read commands
Data
5
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
Response message
during normal
communication
(GOT host) (2) During processing of write commands
ACK 6
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
06H
UNIT
Output
value
During interrupt
DEVICE
output 1/2/4
bytes*1
8
*1 Set the number of interrupt data bytes at [Detail setting] in GT Designer3.
DEVICE CONNECTION
For the setting of the number of interrupt data bytes, refer to the following.
AUTHENTICATION
POINT
Data code during communication
Communication of the format 3 is performed in ASCII code. (excluding interrupt output)
Communication of the format 4 is performed in Binary code.
(2) Command
Specifies the contents to access from the host to GOT.
The command is converted to a 1-digit ASCII code (Hex) and transmitted.
For details of the commands that can be used, refer to the following.
3.4.2 List of commands
(4) Address
Specifies the head No. of the device data to be read/written.
In the format 3, the address notated in hexadecimal is converted to a 4-digit ASCII code (Hex) and transmitted
from the upper digit.
In the format 4, the address notated in hexadecimal is converted to a 2-digit Binary code (binary) and
transmitted from the upper digit.
For details of the device range that can be accessed, refer to the following.
3.3 Device Data Area
PROCEDURES FOR
Specifies how to change the data of the specified address by bit pattern.
(Setting range: 0 to 3)
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
Data notated in decimal is converted to a 1-digit ASCII code (Hex) and transmitted.
■ Message format (3) Multi-point write in bit units (3) command (w/out station No.), multi-point
write in bit units (D) command (w/ station No.)
MICROCOMPUTER
In the format 3, the address notated in hexadecimal is converted to a 2-digit ASCII code (Hex) and transmitted
CONNECTION
from the upper digit.
In the format 4, the address notated in hexadecimal is converted to a 1-digit Binary code (binary) and
(SERIAL)
transmitted.
MICROCOMPUTER
In the format 3, the address notated in decimal is converted to a 2-digit ASCII code (Hex) and transmitted from
the upper digit.
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
In the format 4, the address notated in decimal is converted to a 1-digit Binary code (binary) and transmitted.
(9) Year, month, day, hour, minute, second and day of the week data
Specifies year, month, day, hour, minute, second, and day of the week to be read/set to the GOT clock data.
In the format 3, the address notated in decimal is converted to a 2-digit ASCII code (Hex) and transmitted from 4
the upper digit.
In the format 4, the address notated in decimal is converted to a 1-digit Binary code (binary) and transmitted.
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
■ (5) Read clock data (6) command (w/out station No.), read clock data (G) command (w/station
No.)
■ (6) Set clock data (5) command (w/out station No.), set clock data (F) command (w/station No.)
(10) Data
5
Specifies the data to read from/write to the specified device data. (word unit)
MODBUS(R)/TCP
In the format 3, the address notated in hexadecimal is converted to a 4-digit ASCII code (Hex) and transmitted
CONNECTION
from the upper digit.
In the format 4, the address notated in hexadecimal is converted to a 2-digit Binary code (binary) and
transmitted from the upper digit.
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
R100 3D21H
R101 3604H
Request message
(format 4: GOT-F900 Series microcomputer connection (Binary))
(host GOT)
Com- Station Number
mand No. Address of bytes
3 D 2 1 3 6 0 4
33H 44H 32H 31H 33H 36H 30H 34H
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
Response message
during normal
(format 4: GOT-F900 Series microcomputer connection (Binary))
communication
(GOT host)
Data 1 Data 2 Data 3 Data 4
(R100 upper) (R100 lower) (R101 upper) (R101 lower)
PROCEDURES FOR
(Assuming M0="1" and M31="1" are stored.)
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
M15 to 0 0001H
M31 to 16 8000H
2
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
Item Message format
(SERIAL)
(format 3: GOT-F900 Series microcomputer connection (ASCII))
Com- Number of
mand Station No. Address bytes
A 1 5 2 0 0 0 0 4
3
MICROCOMPUTER
41H 31H 35H 32H 30H 30H 30H 30H 34H
(H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L)
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
Request message
(format 4: GOT-F900 Series microcomputer connection (Binary))
(host GOT)
4
A 0FH 20H 00H 04H
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
(format 3: GOT-F900 Series microcomputer connection (ASCII))
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
00000001000000000000000010000000
MMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMM
Response message
76543210111111982222111133222222
543210 3210987610987654 6
during normal
CONNECTION TO
(format 4: GOT-F900 Series microcomputer connection (Binary))
SOUND OUTPUT
communication
(GOT host)
Data 1 Data 2 Data 3 Data 4
(M7 to 0) (M15 to 8) (M23 to 16) (M31 to 24)
UNIT
00000001000000000000000010000000
MMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMM
DEVICE
76543210111111982222111133222222
543210 3210987610987654
8
Response message NAK
DEVICE CONNECTION
during faulty
AUTHENTICATION
communication
FINGERPRINT
15H
(GOT host)
B 1 5 0 0 C 8 0 4 Following*1
42H 31H 35H 30H 30H 43H 38H 30H 34H
(H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L)
*1
Data 1 Data 2 Data 3 Data 4
(R100 upper) (R100 lower) (R101 upper) (R101 lower)
3 D 2 1 3 6 0 4
33H 44H 32H 31H 33H 36H 30H 34H
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
Request message
(host GOT) (format 4: GOT-F900 Series microcomputer connection (Binary))
Following*2
B 0FH 00H C8H 04H
*2
Data 1 Data 2 Data 3 Data 4
(R100 upper) (R100 lower) (R101 upper) (R101 lower)
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
M15 to 0 0000H M15 to 0 0001H
MICROCOMPUTER
Item Message format
CONNECTION
(format 3: GOT-F900 Series microcomputer connection (ASCII))
(SERIAL)
Com- Station No. Number
mand Address of bytes
Following*1
3
B 1 5 2 0 0 0 0 4
42H 31H 35H 32H 30H 30H 30H 30H 34H
(H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L)
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
*1
(ETHERNET)
Data 1 Data 2 Data 3 Data 4
(M7 to 0) (M15 to 8) (M23 to 16) (M31 to 24)
0 1 0 0 0 0 8 0
30H 31H 30H 30H 30H 30H 38H 30H
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) 4
MODBUS(R)/RTU
00000001000000000000000010000000
CONNECTION
MMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMM
76543210111111982222111133222222
543210 3210987610987654
Request message
(host GOT)
(format 4: GOT-F900 Series microcomputer connection (Binary))
5
Com- Station Address
Number
mand No. of bytes
MODBUS(R)/TCP
Following*2
CONNECTION
B 0FH 20H 00H 04H
*2
Data 1 Data 2 Data 3 Data 4
(M7 to 0) (M15 to 8) (M23 to 16) (M31 to 24) 6
CONNECTION TO
01H 00H 00H 80H
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
00000001000000000000000010000000
MMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMMM
76543210111111982222111133222222
543210 3210987610987654 7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
8
Response message
DEVICE CONNECTION
NAK
during faulty
AUTHENTICATION
communication
FINGERPRINT
*1
Write Write
specification Address1 Bit pattern1 specification Address2 Bit pattern2
1 2
1 2 0 0 3 8 0 0 2 0 F E 4 0
31H 32H 30H 30H 33H 38H 30H 30H 32H 30H 46 45H 34H 30H
(H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L)
*2 *2
(write specification1=1) (write specification2=0)
Source data 10101010 Source data 10101010
bit pattern 10000000 bit pattern 01000000
*3
Write Write
Bit specification Bit
specification Address1 Address2
1 pattern1 2 pattern2
*2 *2
(write (write
specification1=1) specification2=0)
Source data 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 Source data 10101010
bit pattern 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 bit pattern 01000000
PROCEDURES FOR
Write
Function Description Action example
PREPARATORY
specification
MONITORING
Original data 1010
ON
0 Bits set to "1" by the bit pattern are turned ON. Bit pattern 1100
specification
Result 1110
MICROCOMPUTER
specification
Result 0010
CONNECTION
Original data 1010
(SERIAL)
Invert
2 Bits set to "1" by the bit pattern are inverted. Bit pattern 1100
specification
Result 0110
MICROCOMPUTER
specification directly.
Result 1100
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
4
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
5
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
6
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
0000H 1616H
Request message
(format 4: GOT-F900 Series microcomputer connection (Binary))
(host GOT)
POINT
(1) Start address/end address specification conditions
Specify addresses so that the start address is the same or less than the end address.
Error response occurs in the following cases:
• The address to specify has the start address greater than the end address.
• Either of the start address or end address exceeds the device range that can be specified.
PROCEDURES FOR
The following shows an example of reading the clock data of GOT at station No.27.
(Assuming that the clock data of GOT has been set to "2009, October 1, 18:46:49, Thursday".)
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
Time display
2009/10/01 18:46:49 THU
MICROCOMPUTER
Item Message format
CONNECTION
(format 3: GOT-F900 Series microcomputer connection (ASCII))
(SERIAL)
Com-
mand Station No.
G 2 7
47H 32H 37H 3
(H) (L)
Request message
MICROCOMPUTER
(host GOT)
(format 4: GOT-F900 Series microcomputer connection (Binary))
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
Com- Station
mand No.
G 1BH
4
(format 3: GOT-F900 Series microcomputer connection (ASCII))
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
Day-of-
Year data Month data Day data Hour data Minute data Second data week data
0 9 1 0 0 1 1 8 4 6 4 9 0 4
30H 39H 31H 30H 30H 31H 31H 38H 34H 36H 34H 39H 30H 34H
Response message
during normal
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
5
communication
(format 4: GOT-F900 Series microcomputer connection (Binary))
(GOT host)
MODBUS(R)/TCP
Year Month Day Hour Minute Second Day-of-
CONNECTION
data data data data data data week data
6
Response message NAK
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
during faulty
communication
(GOT host) 15H
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
Time display
2009/10/01 18:46:49 THU
After execution
POINT
When a wrong day of the week has been set by the clock data setting command
If a wrong day of the week is set by the clock data setting commands, the clock data will differ from the time
displayed on the utility.
Example: When October 1, 2009 (Tuesday) is set by the clock data setting command (the actual day of the week is
Thursday), Thursday (THU) will be displayed on the utility time display.
PROCEDURES FOR
The following shows an example of an interrupt output when data are written to the interrupt output devices (D13
and D14).
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
(Assuming that "3139H" is written to D13 and "AA55H" to D14.)
D13 3139H
2
MICROCOMPUTER
Interrupt
CONNECTION
(SERIAL)
Interrupt output
Output Output
value 1 value 2
3
31H 39H
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
Item Message format
(1) When [Interrupt Data Byte] in "Communication Detail Settings" is set to "1 byte"
Output
value 1 4
MODBUS(R)/RTU
39H
CONNECTION
(2) When [Interrupt Data Byte] in "Communication Detail Settings" is set to "2 byte"
Output Output
Interrupt output
(GOT host)
value 1 value 2
5
31H 39H
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
(3) When [Interrupt Data Byte] in "Communication Detail Settings" is set to "4 byte"
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
POINT UNIT
Interrupt output
• To disable the interrupt output, turn ON SM52 (interrupt code output disable flag). ( 3.3.6 SM devices) 7
• To enable the interrupt output, set 8 bits to the data length at "Communication Detail Settings".
CONNECTION TO
• When "7 bits" is set, the MSB (8th bit) is ignored.(Example: FFH 7FH)
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
Precautions
(1) Batch reading/writing crossing over different devices
When using the batch read (0, A) or batch write (1, B) command, do not batch read/write crossing over different
devices.
This will cause an error response.
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
2
Basic format of data communication
MICROCOMPUTER
This is the same format as the protocol of the Digital Electronics Corporation's memory link method.
CONNECTION
For details of the basic format of data communication, refer to the following manual:
(SERIAL)
The connection manual of the device manufactured by Digital Electronics Corporation
This section describes items whose settings differ from the protocols of the Digital Electronics Corporation's memory
link method and dedicated commands for a microcomputer connection of GOT. 3
Example:Request message for the batch read in word units (R) command in format 5
MICROCOMPUTER
(Digital Electronics Corporation's memory link method)
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
Number
Data length ESC Com- Address
mand of points
B R
4
42H 00H 00H 00H 00H 00H 00H 06H 1BH 52H 00H 64H 00H 02H
MODBUS(R)/RTU
Details of data items in message format
CONNECTION
POINT
Data code during communication 5
Communication is performed in ASCII code.
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
(1) Command
Specifies the contents to access from the host to GOT.
The command is converted to a 1-digit ASCII code (Hex) and transmitted.
For details of the commands that can be used, refer to the following. 6
3.4.2 List of commands
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
(2) Address
Specifies the head No. of the device data to be read/written.
The address notated in hexadecimal is converted to a 4-digit ASCII code (Hex) and transmitted from the upper
UNIT
digit.
For details of the device range that can be accessed, refer to the following.
7
3.3 Device Data Area
CONNECTION TO
digit.
(4) Error code
This is the response message at faulty communication appended with error contents. 8
The address notated in hexadecimal is converted to a 2-digit ASCII code (Hex) and transmitted from the upper
DEVICE CONNECTION
digit.
AUTHENTICATION
For details of error codes generated in format 5 (Digital Electronics Corporation's memory link method), refer to
FINGERPRINT
the following:
■ Error code list
PROCEDURES FOR
The following shows the message format of the dedicated commands for a microcomputer connection of GOT.
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
(1) Batch read in word units (R) command
The following shows an example of reading the two points of the virtual devices D100 and D101.
(Assuming D100=0102H, D101=0304H are stored.)
2
D100 0102H
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
D101 0304H
(SERIAL)
Item Message format
3
Number
MICROCOMPUTER
Data length ESC Com- Address
mand of points
Request message
CONNECTION
B R
(ETHERNET)
(host GOT)
42H 00H 00H 00H 00H 00H 00H 06H 1BH 52H 00H 64H 00H 02H
Number
4
Response message Data length ESC Com- Address
mand of points
during normal
MODBUS(R)/RTU
communication b A
CONNECTION
(GOT host) 42H 00H 00H 00H 00H 00H 00H 06H 1BH 41H 01H 02H 03H 04H
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
D100 0000H D100 0064H
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
Item Message format
UNIT
Number
Data length ESC Com- Address Data 1 Data 2
mand of points
Request message
(host GOT)
B W 7
42H 00H 00H 00H 00H 00H 00H 0AH 1BH 57H 00H 64H 00H 02H 00H 64H 00H 65H
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
(GOT host) 42H 00H 00H 00H 00H 00H 00H 06H 06H 8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
D13 31H
Interrupt
Interrupt output
Output
value 1
31H
When [Interrupt Data Byte] in "Communication Detail Settings" is set to "1 byte"
Output
Interrupt output value 1
(GOT host)
31H
POINT
Interrupt output
• To disable the interrupt output, turn ON SM52 (interrupt code output disable flag).
( 3.3.6 SM devices)
• To enable the interrupt output, set 8 bits to the data length at "Communication Detail Settings".
( 3.5.1 Setting communication interface (Communication settings))
• When "7 bits" is set, the MSB (8th bit) is ignored. (Example: FFH 7FH)
PROCEDURES FOR
In the case of format 5 (Digital Electronics Corporation's memory link method), the details (error code) of the error are
PREPARATORY
appended to the response message during faulty communication.
MONITORING
The following shows error code, error contents, cause, and measures.
10H
Command error
An unsupported command was used. • Review the contents of the message to transmit.
2
• Check the commands in the message.
MICROCOMPUTER
Message length error
12H The upper limit of the data length that can be received by ( 3.4.2 List of commands)
CONNECTION
the GOT has been exceeded.
(SERIAL)
• Review the contents of the message to transmit.
Address error
FAH • Check whether the non-existent data is set (e.g. setting "07" at the day of
The start address of the read/write device is out of range.
the week) as clock data.
MICROCOMPUTER
( 3.3 Device Data Area)
CONNECTION
Message format error • Check the settings of "Communication Detail Settings".
(ETHERNET)
FCH
The format of the received message has error. • Review the contents of the message to transmit.
Timeout error • Check the communication cable and communication module attachment.
FFH There is no response from the GOT, or the station of the • Check the settings of "Communication Detail Settings".
specified address does not exist. • Review the contents of the message to transmit.
4
Precautions
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
(1) Batch reading/writing crossing over different devices
When using the batch read (R) or batch write (W) command, do not batch read/write crossing over the different
devices.
This will cause an error response.
5
(2) Storage order for 32-bit data
To use the program of Digital Electronics Corporation's memory link method with [32bit Order] setting to
MODBUS(R)/TCP
GOT1000 series, set [HL Order] to [32bit Order] for [Communication Detail Settings] when 32-bit data is set for
CONNECTION
GOT-A900 series.
With setting [LH Order], the order of upper bits and lower bits are reversed when the GOT displays and writes
32-bit data.
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
Request type Serial No. Fixed value Network PLC No. Request destination Request destination
No. module I/O No. module station No.
Following
5 4 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 0
*1
35H 34H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 31H 30H 31H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) – (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L)
*1
0 0 1 8 0 0 0 0 0 4 0 1 1)
30H 30H 31H 38H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 34H 30H 31H
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) – – (L)
Character A section
Sub-command Device
code Head Device Device points
1) 0 0 0 0 D * 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 2
30H 30H 30H 30H 44H 2AH 30H 30H 30H 31H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 32H
(H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) – – – – (L) (H) – – (L)
54H 00H 00H 00H 00H 00H 01H 01H 00H 00H 00H 0CH 00H 00H 00H 01H 04H 00H 00H 64H 00H 00H A8H 02H 00H
POINT
Data code during communication
Communication of format 6 is performed in ASCII code.
Communication of the format 7 is performed in Binary code.
PROCEDURES FOR
Contents
Data item name
PREPARATORY
Format 6 Format 7
MONITORING
Request type Indicates it is a command message.
(Microcomputer
side) Command message: ASCII "5400" (Fixed value) Command message: 54H (Upper digit) (Fixed value)
MICROCOMPUTER
Arbitrary number for recognition of the message appended at the microcomputer side. GOT sends the response message appending
Serial No.
this Serial No.
CONNECTION
Fixed value Should be ASCII "0000". Should be "0000H".
(SERIAL)
Set the same number as the network No. set in the GOT.
For setting method of "Communication Detail Settings", refer to the following.
MICROCOMPUTER
digit.
CONNECTION
Set the same number as the PLC No. set in the GOT.
(ETHERNET)
For setting method of "Communication Detail Settings", refer to the following.
Transmit the data converted to a 2-digit ASCII code from the upper
Transmit the data converted to a 2-digit binary code.
digit.
Request destination
4
Ignore GOT.
module I/O No.
MODBUS(R)/RTU
Request destination
CONNECTION
Ignore GOT.
module station No.
Number of bytes from the start of CPU monitoring timer to the last request data.
Request data length Transmit the data converted to a 4-digit ASCII code from the upper Transmit the data converted to a 4-digit binary code from the lower
digit. two digits.
MODBUS(R)/TCP
length Transmit the data converted to a 4-digit ASCII code from the upper Transmit the data converted to a 4-digit binary code from the lower
CONNECTION
digit. two digits.
CPU monitoring
Ignore GOT.
timer
Specifies the access contents from the microcomputer side to GOT. For details of the commands that can be used, refer to the following.
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
ASCII code, from the upper digit. two digits.
Transmit the 2-digit ASCII code corresponding to the following Transmit the 2-digit binary code corresponding to the following
device codes. device codes. 7
Device name Device code Device name Device code
Device code
CONNECTION TO
M M* M 90H
EXTERNAL I/O
SM SM SM 91H
L L* L 92H
DEVICE
D D* D A8H
SD SD SD A9H
R R* R AFH
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
Transmit the data notated in decimal converted to a 6-digit Transmit the data converted to a 6-digit binary code from the lower
ASCII code, from the upper digit. two digits.
Transmit the data notated in decimal converted to a 4-digit Transmit the data converted to a 4-digit binary code from the lower
ASCII code, from the upper digit. two digits.
Specifies year, month, day, hour, minute, second, and day of the week to be read/set to the GOT clock data.
Year, month, day, ■ Message format (1) Read clock data (1901) command
hour,
■ Message format (2) Set clock data (0901) command
minute, second and
day
of the week data Transmit the data notated in decimal converted to a 2-digit
Transmit the data converted to a 2-digit binary code.
ASCII code, from the upper digit.
Appended to the response message from the microcomputer side. If an error occurs at the microcomputer side, the error code is
displayed.
End code
(Microcomputer ■ Error code list
side)
Transmit the data notated in hexadecimal converted to a 4-digit Transmit the data converted to a 4-digit binary code from the lower
ASCII code, from the upper digit. two digits.
POINT
When connecting a microcomputer, etc. that uses the MC protocol of the Q/QnA series serial communication
module with the GOT
When connecting a microcomputer, etc. that uses the MC protocol of the Q/QnA series serial communication
module with the GOT, correct the commands to be used and the device ranges to match the GOT specifications.
PROCEDURES FOR
The following shows the message format of the dedicated commands for a microcomputer connection of GOT.
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
(1) Read clock data (1901) command
The following shows an example of reading the clock data of GOT.
(Assuming that the clock data of GOT has been set to "2009, October 1, 18:46:49, Thursday".)
Time display
2
MICROCOMPUTER
2009/10/01 18:46:49 THU
CONNECTION
(SERIAL)
Item Message format
Network
3
Request type Serial No. Fixed value PLC No.
No.
MICROCOMPUTER
5 4 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 1 Following
CONNECTION
*1
(ETHERNET)
35H 34H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 31H 30H 31H
(H) – – (L) (H) – – (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
*1
Request destination Request destination
Request data length CPU monitoring timer
4
module I/O No. module station No.
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 C 0 0 0 0 1)
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 43H 30H 30H 30H 30H
(H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) – – (L)
Character A section
Request message
Command Sub-command 5
(host GOT) 1) 1 9 0 1 0 0 0 0
MODBUS(R)/TCP
31H 39H 30H 31H 30H 30H 30H 30H
CONNECTION
(H) – – (L) (H) – – (L)
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
Data length target range
*1
UNIT
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
Network
Response type Serial No. Fixed value PLC No.
No.
D 4 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 1 Following
*1
44H 34H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 31H 30H 31H
(H) – – (L) (H) – – (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
*1
Request destination Request destination
module I/O No. module station No.
Response data length End code
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 2 0 0 0 0 1)
30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 31H 32H 30H 30H 30H 30H
(H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) – – (L)
Character B section
Response message
Year data Month data Day data Hour data Minute data Second Day-of-
during normal data week data
communication
1) 0 9 1 0 0 1 1 8 4 6 4 9 0 4
(GOT host)
30H 39H 31H 30H 30H 31H 31H 38H 34H 36H 34H 39H 30H 34H
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
Request
Request Network PLC Request destination destination Response
type Serial No. Fixed value No. No. module I/O No. module
data length
station No.
Following
*1
D4H 00H 00H 00H 00H 00H 01H 01H 00H 00H 00H 09H 00H
PROCEDURES FOR
Item Message format
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
(format 6:4E frame (ASCII))
Network
Response type Serial No. Fixed value PLC No.
No.
D 4 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 1 Following
44H 34H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 31H 30H 31H
*1
2
(H) – – (L) (H) – – (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(SERIAL)
*1
Request destination Request destination
module I/O No. module station No.
Response data length End code
0
30H
0
30H
0
30H
0
30H
0
30H
0
30H
0
30H
0
30H
1
31H
6
36H
0
30H
0
30H
5
35H
6
36H
1)
3
(H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) – – (L)
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
Response message Network
PLC No. Request destination Request destination
Command Sub-command
during faulty No. module I/O No. module station No.
communication
1) 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 9 0 1 0 0 0 0
(GOT host)
30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 31H 39H 30H 31H 30H 30H 30H 30H 4
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) – – (L)
MODBUS(R)/RTU
(format 7:4E frame (Binary))
CONNECTION
Request
Request PLC Request destination Response
Serial No. Fixed value Network
destination
module
type No. No. module I/O No. station No. data length
Following
*1
D4H 00H 00H 00H 00H 00H 01H 01H 00H 00H 00H 0BH 00H
MODBUS(R)/TCP
Data length target range
CONNECTION
*1
Request
Network PLC Request destination destination Sub-
End code module I/O No. module Command command
No. No. station No.
6
56H 00H 00H 00H 00H 00H 00H 01H 19H 00H 00H
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
Time display
2009/10/01 18:46:49 THU
After execution
Network
Response type Serial No. Fixed value PLC No.
No.
5 4 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 1 Following
*1
35H 34H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 31H 30H 31H
(H) – – (L) (H) – – (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
*1
Request destination Request destination
Request data length CPU monitoring timer Command
module I/O No. module station No.
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 A 0 0 0 0 0 9 0 1 1)
30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 31H 41H 30H 30H 30H 30H 31H 39H 30H 31H
(H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) – – (L) (H) – – (L)
Character C section
Year data Month data Day data Hour data Minute data Second Day-of-
Request message Sub-command
data week data
(host GOT)
1) 0 0 0 0 0 9 1 0 0 1 1 8 4 6 4 9 0 4
30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 39H 31H 30H 30H 31H 31H 38H 34H 36H 34H 39H 30H 34H
(H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
00H 00H 01H 09H 00H 00H 09H 0AH 01H 12H 2EH 31H 04H
PROCEDURES FOR
Item Message format
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
(format 6:4E frame (ASCII))
Network
Response type Serial No. Fixed value PLC No.
No.
D 4 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 1 Following
44H 34H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 31H 30H 31H
*1
2
(H) – – (L) (H) – – (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(SERIAL)
*1
Response message Request destination Request destination
module I/O No. module station No.
Response data length End code
during normal
communication
(GOT host)
0
30H
0
30H
0
30H
0
30H
0
30H
0
30H
0
30H
0
30H
0
30H
4
34H
0
30H
0
30H
0
30H
0
30H
3
(H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) – – (L)
MICROCOMPUTER
(format 7:4E frame (Binary))
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
Data length
target range
Request
Request Network PLC Request destination destination Response End code
Serial No. Fixed value No. No. module
4
type module I/O No. station No. data length
D4H 00H 00H 00H 00H 00H 01H 01H 00H 00H 00H 02H 00H 00H 00H
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
(Continued to next page)
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
6
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
Network
Response type Serial No. Fixed value PLC No.
No.
D 4 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 1 Following
*1
44H 34H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 31H 30H 31H
(H) – – (L) (H) – – (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
*1
Request destination Request destination
module I/O No. module station No.
Response data length End code
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 6 0 0 5 6 1)
30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 31H 36H 30H 30H 35H 36H
(H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) – – (L)
Request
Request Response
type Serial No. Fixed value Network PLC Request destination destination
module
No. No. module I/O No. station No. data length
Following*1
D4H 00H 00H 00H 00H 00H 01H 01H 00H 00H 00H 0BH 0H
56H 00H 00H 00H 00H 00H 00H 01H 09H 00H 00H
POINT
When a wrong day of the week has been set by the clock data setting command
If a wrong day of the week is set by the clock data setting commands, the clock data will differ from the time
displayed on the utility.
Example: When October 1, 2009 (Tuesday) is set by the clock data setting command (the actual day of the week is
Thursday), Thursday (THU) will be displayed on the utility time display.
PROCEDURES FOR
The following shows error code, error contents, cause, and measures.
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
Error code Description Action
Device point error • Check the specified head device and number of points, and correct it.
0002H
The specification of device range to read/write has error. ( 3.3 Device Data Area)
MICROCOMPUTER
response type.
CONNECTION
Device error • Check the devices that can be used and the device ranges.
0056H
A non-existent device has been specified. ( 3.3 Device Data Area)
(SERIAL)
Device point error
• The command number of points specification from the
microcomputer exceeds the maximum number of points
processed at each process (number of points processed in
• Correct the specified number of points, or the start address (device
number).
3
one communication).
MICROCOMPUTER
• The start address (head device number) to specified ( 3.3 Device Data Area)
0057H
number of points exceeds the maximum address (device
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
number, step number) for each process.
MODBUS(R)/RTU
• Correct the values to values that can be specified in each process.
• Value outside the GOT parameter setting range is specified
CONNECTION
0058H in the microcomputer program and file register (R) reading/
writing.
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
00A2H Request cannot be processed. • Correct the request content and command.
C0D6H The specification of network No. and station No. have error. • Review the network No., station No. specification method.
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
Character A section
*1
Device
CPU monitoring timer Command Sub-command Start Device Device points
code
0 0 0 0 0 4 0 1 0 0 0 0 D * 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 2
30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 34H 30H 31H 30H 30H 30H 30H 44H 2AH 30H 30H 30H 31H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 32H
(H) (L) (H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) – – – – (L) (H) – – (L)
50H 00H 01H 01H 00H 00H 00H 0CH 00H 00H 00H 01H 04H 00H 00H 64H 00H 00H A8H 02H 00H
POINT
Data code during communication
Communication of format 8 is performed in ASCII code.
Communication of the format 9 is performed in Binary code.
PROCEDURES FOR
Contents
Data item name
PREPARATORY
Format 8 Format 9
MONITORING
Subheader Indicates it is a command message.
(Microcomputer
side) Command message: ASCII "5000" (Fixed value) Command message: 50H (Upper digit) (Fixed value)
MICROCOMPUTER
Set the same number as the network No. set in the GOT.
For setting method of "Communication Detail Settings", refer to the following.
CONNECTION
Network No. 3.5.1 Setting communication interface (Communication settings)
(SERIAL)
Transmit the data converted to a 2-digit ASCII code from the upper
Transmit the data converted to a 2-digit binary code.
digit.
Set the same number as the PLC No. set in the GOT.
For setting method of "Communication Detail Settings", refer to the following.
3
3.5.1 Setting communication interface (Communication settings)
MICROCOMPUTER
PLC No.
Transmit the data converted to a 2-digit ASCII code from the upper
CONNECTION
Transmit the data converted to a 2-digit binary code.
(ETHERNET)
digit.
Request destination
Ignore GOT.
module I/O No.
Request destination
module station No.
Ignore GOT. 4
Number of bytes from the start of CPU monitoring timer to the last request data.
MODBUS(R)/RTU
Request data length Transmit the data converted to a 4-digit ASCII code from the upper Transmit the data converted to a 4-digit binary code from the lower
CONNECTION
digit. two digits.
MODBUS(R)/TCP
timer
CONNECTION
Specifies the access contents from the microcomputer side to GOT. For details of the commands that can be used, refer to the following.
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
3.3 Device Data Area
Transmit the 2-digit ASCII code corresponding to the following Transmit the 2-digit binary code corresponding to the following
device codes. device codes. UNIT
Device name Device code Device name Device code
Device code
M M* M 90H
SM SM SM 91H 7
L L* L 92H
D D* D A8H
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
SD SD SD A9H
R R* R AFH
DEVICE
Transmit the data notated in decimal converted to a 4-digit Transmit the data converted to a 4-digit binary code from the lower
ASCII code, from the upper digit. two digits.
Specifies year, month, day, hour, minute, second, and day of the week to be read/set to the GOT clock data.
Year, month, day,
hour, ■ Message format (1) Read clock data (1901) command
minute, second and ■ Message format (2) Set clock data (0901) command
day
Transmit the data notated in decimal converted to a 2-digit
of the week data Transmit the data converted to a 2-digit binary code.
ASCII code, from the upper digit.
Appended to the response message from the microcomputer side. If an error occurs at the microcomputer side, the error code is
displayed.
End code
(Microcomputer ■ Error code list
side)
Transmit the data notated in hexadecimal converted to a 4-digit Transmit the data converted to a 4-digit binary code from the lower
ASCII code, from the upper digit. two digits.
POINT
When connecting a microcomputer, etc. that uses the MC protocol of the Q/QnA series serial communication
module with the GOT
When connecting a microcomputer, etc. that uses the MC protocol of the Q/QnA series serial communication
module with the GOT, correct the commands to be used and the device ranges to match the GOT specifications.
PROCEDURES FOR
The following shows the message format of the dedicated commands for a microcomputer connection of GOT.
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
(1) Read clock data (1901) command
The following shows an example of reading the clock data of GOT.
(Assuming that the clock data of GOT has been set to "2009, October 1, 18:46:49, Thursday".)
2
Time display
MICROCOMPUTER
2009/10/01 18:46:49 THU
CONNECTION
(SERIAL)
Item Message format
MICROCOMPUTER
station No.
Following
5 0 0 0 0 1 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 *1
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
35H 30H 30H 30H 30H 31H 30H 31H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H
(H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L)
Character A section
*1
MODBUS(R)/RTU
30H 30H 30H 43H 30H 30H 30H 30H 31H 39H 30H 31H 30H 30H 30H 30H
(host GOT)
CONNECTION
(H) – – (L) (H) – – (L) (H) – – (L) (H) – – (L)
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
50H 00H 01H 01H 00H 00H 00H 06H 00H 00H 00H 01H 19H 00H 00H
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
Request
Network Request destination destination
Subheader PLC No. Response data length
No. module I/O No. module station No.
Following
D 0 0 0 0 1 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 2
*1
44H 30H 30H 30H 30H 31H 30H 31H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 31H 32H
(H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) – – (L)
Character B section
*1
Second Day-of-
End code Year data Month data Day data Hour data Minute data
data week data
Response message
during normal 0 0 0 0 0 9 1 0 0 1 1 8 4 6 4 9 0 4
communication 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 39H 31H 30H 30H 31H 31H 38H 34H 36H 34H 39H 30H 34H
(GOT host) (H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
Request
PLC Request Response Year Month Day Hour Minute Second Day-of-
Subheader Network
destination
destination module End code data data data data data data week data
No. No. module I/O No. station No. data length
D0H 00H 01H 01H 00H 00H 00H 09H 00H 00H 00H 09H 0AH 01H 12H 2EH 31H 04H
PROCEDURES FOR
Item Message format
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
(format 8:QnA compatible 3E frame (ASCII))
Request
Network Request destination destination
Subheader PLC No. Response data length
No. module I/O No. module station No.
Following
D 0 0 0 0 1 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 6
2
*1
44H 30H 30H 30H 30H 31H 30H 31H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 31H 36H
(H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) – – (L)
MICROCOMPUTER
*1
CONNECTION
Request
Network Request destination destination
End code PLC No. module station No.
(SERIAL)
No. module I/O No.
0 0 5 6 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1)
30H 30H 35H 36H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H
(H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L)
3
Data length target data
MICROCOMPUTER
Command Sub-command
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
Response message
1) 1 9 0 1 0 0 0 0
during faulty
communication 31H 39H 30H 31H 30H 30H 30H 30H
(GOT host) (H) – – (L) (H) – – (L)
MODBUS(R)/RTU
Request Request
PLC Response
CONNECTION
Network destination
Subheader No. destination module
No. module I/O No. station No. data length
Following
*1
D0H 00H 01H 01H 00H 00H 00H 0BH 00H
*1
5
Request
Network PLC Request destination Sub-
End code destination module Command
MODBUS(R)/TCP
No. No. command
module I/O No. station No.
CONNECTION
56H 00H 00H 00H 00H 00H 00H 01H 19H 00H 00H
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
Time display
2009/10/01 18:46:49 THU
After execution
Request
Network Request destination destination
Subheader PLC No.
No. module I/O No. module station No.
Following
5 0 0 0 0 1 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 *1
35H 30H 30H 30H 30H 31H 30H 31H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H
(H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L)
*1
0 0 1 A 0 0 0 0 0 9 0 1 1)
30H 30H 31H 41H 30H 30H 30H 30H 31H 39H 30H 31H
(H) – – (L) (H) – – (L) (H) – – (L)
Second Day-of-
Sub-command Year data Month data Day data Hour data Minute data
data week data
Request message 1) 0 0 0 0 0 9 1 0 0 1 1 8 4 6 4 9 0 4
(host GOT) 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 39H 31H 30H 30H 31H 31H 38H 34H 36H 34H 39H 30H 34H
(H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) (L)
Request
Network PLC Request destination Request
Subheader No. destination module
No. module I/O No. station No. data length
Following
*1
50H 00H 01H 01H 00H 00H 00H 0DH 00H
*1
CPU Sub- Year Month Day Hour Minute Second Day-of-
Command
monitoring timer command data data data data data data week data
00H 00H 01H 09H 00H 00H 09H 0AH 01H 12H 2EH 31H 04H
PROCEDURES FOR
Item Message format
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
(format 8:QnA compatible 3E frame (ASCII))
Request
Network Request destination
Subheader PLC No. destination
No. module I/O No. module station No.
D 0 0 0 0 1 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 Following
44H 30H 30H 30H 30H 31H 30H 31H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H
*1
2
(H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L)
MICROCOMPUTER
*1
CONNECTION
Response data length End code
(SERIAL)
Response message 0 0 0 4 0 0 0 0
during normal
30H 30H 30H 34H 30H 30H 30H 30H
communication
(GOT host)
(H) – – (L) (H) – – (L)
3
Data length target data
MICROCOMPUTER
(format 9:QnA compatible 3E frame (Binary))
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
Request
PLC Request destination Response
Subheader Network No. destination module End code
No. module I/O No. station No. data length
D0H 00H 01H 01H 00H 00H 00H 02H 00H 00H 00H
4
Data length
MODBUS(R)/RTU
target data
CONNECTION
(Continued to next page)
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
6
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
Request
Network Request destination destination
Subheader PLC No. Response data length
No. module I/O No. module station No.
D 0 0 0 0 1 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 6 Following
*1
44H 30H 30H 30H 30H 31H 30H 31H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 31H 36H
(H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) – – (L)
*1
Request
Network Request destination destination
End code PLC No.
No. module I/O No. module station No.
0 0 5 6 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1)
30H 30H 35H 36H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H 30H
(H) – – (L) (H) (L) (H) (L) (H) – – (L) (H) (L)
Command Sub-command
Response message
1) 0 9 0 1 0 0 0 0
during faulty
communication 30H 39H 30H 31H 30H 30H 30H 30H
(GOT host) (H) – – (L) (H) – – (L)
Request
Network PLC Request destination Response
Subheader No. destination module
No. module I/O No. station No. data length
Following
*1
D0H 00H 01H 01H 00H 00H 00H 0BH 00H
*1
Request Request
PLC Sub-
End code Network destination
destination module Command
No. No. module I/O No. station No. command
56H 00H 00H 00H 00H 00H 00H 01H 09H 00H 00H
POINT
When a wrong day of the week has been set by the clock data setting command
If a wrong day of the week is set by the clock data setting commands, the clock data will differ from the time
displayed on the utility.
Example: When October 1, 2009 (Tuesday) is set by the clock data setting command (the actual day of the week is
Thursday), Thursday (THU) will be displayed on the utility time display.
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
3.5.1 Setting communication
3.5.2 Communication detail settings
interface (Communication
settings) Make the settings according to the usage environment.
GT16, GT14
2
Set the channel of the equipment to be connected to the
MICROCOMPUTER
GOT.
CONNECTION
2.
(SERIAL)
3. 3
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
4.
MODBUS(R)/RTU
Item Description Range
CONNECTION
0.0.0.0 to
Set the IP address of the GOT.
GOT IP Address*1 255.255.255.
(Default: 192.168.3.18)
255
Click! Set the subnet mask for the
sub network. (Only for
Subnet Mask*1
connection via router)
If the sub network is not used,
0.0.0.0 to
255.255.255. 5
255
the default value is set.
1.
MODBUS(R)/TCP
Select [Common] [Controller Setting] from the (Default: 255.255.255.0)
CONNECTION
menu. Set the router address of the
default gateway where the 0.0.0.0 to
2. The Controller Setting window is displayed. Select the Default Gateway*1 GOT is connected. (Only for 255.255.255.
connection via router) 255
channel to be used from the list menu.
(Default: 0.0.0.0)
CONNECTION TO
Ethernet Download
SOUND OUTPUT
• Controller Type: Computer Ethernet download. (Except for
Port No.
• I/F: Interface to be used (Default: 5014) 5011, 5012,
5013 and
• Driver: Ethernet (MICROCOMPUTER)
49153)
UNIT
5013 and
3.5.2 Communication detail settings
EXTERNAL I/O
49153)
Specify the time period from
DEVICE
Click the [OK] button when settings are completed. the GOT startup until GOT
Startup Time starts the communication with 3 to 255sec
the PLC CPU.
POINT (Default: 3sec)
8
Set the delay time for reducing
DEVICE CONNECTION
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
(1) Special Interrupt Code
The following shows the compatibility between the
special interrupt codes and the event types.
Special
Interrupt Code Event type 2
(Hex)
MICROCOMPUTER
Base Screen*1 and Overlap Window*1
CONNECTION
Output when the screens are switched according to the
change in the switching device values assigned to 1/2.
(SERIAL)
*1: Base Screen or Overlap Window 1/2 switches
20H independently without being interlocked.
(Example of output)
When all the switching device values assigned to 3
the Base Screen and Overlap Window1/2 are
MICROCOMPUTER
changed, 3 special interrupt codes are output.
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
Output when Recipe data transfer (read-out, write-in) is
22H
completed.
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
changed on the Utility's [Communication setting]
after writing [Communication Settings] of project
data.
For details on the Utility, refer to the following
manual.
User's Manual of GOT used. 5
(2) Precedence in communication settings
MODBUS(R)/TCP
When settings are made by GT Designer3 or the
CONNECTION
Utility, the latest setting is effective.
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
System configuration
The system configuration example illustrated below is explained in this section.
IBM-PC/AT-compatible PC
(Microsoft® Visual C++® Ver.6.0)
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
The device ranges of controller that can be used for GOT are as follows.
Note that the device ranges in the following tables are the maximum values that can be set in GT Designer3.
The device specifications of controllers may differ depending on the models, even though belonging to the same series.
Please make the setting according to the specifications of the controller actually used.
When a non-existent device or a device number outside the range is set, other objects with correct device settings may
not be monitored. 2
MICROCOMPUTER
Setting item
CONNECTION
(SERIAL)
3
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
Item Description 4
Set the device name, device number, and bit number.
Device
MODBUS(R)/RTU
The bit number can be set only when specifying the bit of word device.
CONNECTION
Information Displays the device type and setting range which are selected in [Device].
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
Word device bit Specified bit of the following word devices
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
UDP/IP connection
When the commands are sent from multiple controllers
simultaneously, the GOT may not receive all the
commands.
Retry sending the commands on the controller, to
receive them on the GOT again.
Interrupt output
The interrupt output is effective only at TCP/IP
connection.
At UDP/IP connection, the interrupt output is not
enabled.
4. MODBUS(R)/RTU CONNECTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 1
5. MODBUS(R)/TCP CONNECTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 1
4
1
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
2
MICROCOMPUTER
MODBUS(R)/RTU CONNECTION
CONNECTION
(SERIAL)
4.
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
4.1 Connectable Model List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 2
4
4.2 System Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 3
MODBUS(R)/RTU
4.3 Connection Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 4
CONNECTION
4.4 GOT Side Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 12
4.5 MODBUS(R)/RTU Equipment Side Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 14
4.6 Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4 - 18 5
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
6
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
4-1
4. MODBUS(R)/RTU CONNECTION
POINT
Compatible hardware version for the RS-422/485 connection
The following GOT models are compatible with the RS-422/485 connection.
For the confirming method of hardware version, refer to the following.
GT16 User’s Manual (Hardware)
GT15 User's Manual
GT14 User's Manual
GT11 User's Manual
GT10 User's Manual
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
4.2.1 Connecting to MODBUS(R)/RTU equipment
Communication driver
MODBUS®/RTU
equipment GOT
MODBUS/RTU
2
MICROCOMPUTER
Connection cable
CONNECTION
(SERIAL)
Connection cable GOT Number of
Controller
Communic
ation Type
Cable model Max.
Option device Model
connectable 3
Connection diagram number distance equipment
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
- (Built into GOT)
(ETHERNET)
RS232 connection diagram
15m*1 1 MODBUS
1)
RS-232 equipment for 1
GT15-RS2-9P GOT
FA-LTBGTR4CBL05(0.5m)*2
MODBUS(R)/RTU
RS422/485 connection
1200m*1 FA-LTBGTR4CBL10(1m)*2
CONNECTION
diagram 1)
FA-LTBGTR4CBL20(2m)*2
RS422/485 connection
1200m*1 - (Built into GOT)
diagram 2)
MODBUS®/RTU
equipment RS422/485 connection
GT16-C02R4-9S(0.2m)
5
1200m *1 GT15-RS4-9S
diagram 3)
GT15-RS2T4-9P*4
MODBUS(R)/TCP
Up to 31 MODBUS
CONNECTION
RS-422/ RS422/485 connection equipment for 1
1200m*1 - (Built into GOT)
485 diagram 4) GOT
*3
RS422/485 connection
1200m*1 GT10-9PT5S*5
diagram 5)
RS422/485 connection
6
1200m*1 - (Built into GOT)
diagram 6)
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
RS422/485 connection
1200m*1 GT15-RS4-TE
diagram 7)
RS422/485 connection
1200m*1 GT14-RS2T4-9P*6
UNIT
diagram 8)
*1
*2
The shortest specification on the MODBUS®/RTU equipment side is prioritized.
Product manufactured by MITSUBISHI ELECTRIC ENGINEERING COMPANY LIMITED.
7
For details of the product, contact MITSUBISHI ELECTRIC ENGINEERING COMPANY LIMITED.
CONNECTION TO
*3 When it is less than 31 units, the number of the maximum connectable units on the MODBUS®/RTU equipment side will apply.
EXTERNAL I/O
*4 Connect it to the RS-232 interface (built into GOT). It cannot be mounted on GT1655, GT155 .
*5 Connect it to the RS-422 interface (built into GOT).
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
SG 5 SG
DR(DSR) 6 -
RS(RTS) 7 -
CS(CTS) 8 -
NC 9 -
SD RxD
RD TxD
ER -
DR -
SG SG
RS -
CS -
PROCEDURES FOR
The following shows the connection diagrams and connector specifications of the RS-422/485 cable used for connecting
the GOT to a PLC.
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
RS-422/485 cable 1) (2 pair wiring)
CON side(20 pin)*3 MODBUS®/RTU equipment side*1*2*4 MODBUS®/RTU equipment side*1*2*4
SDA1(TXD1+) *5 RDA(+) RDA(+)
6
R *5 RDB(-) RDB(-)
SDB1(TXD1-)
*3 RDA1(RXD1+) *5
8
10
SDA(+) SDA(+) 2
R RDB1(RXD1-) *5 SDB(-) SDB(-)
12
MICROCOMPUTER
*3 SG SG
SG 2
CONNECTION
NC 1
NC 3
(SERIAL)
NC 4
SDA2(TXD2+) 5
3
SDB2(TXD2-) 7
RDA2(RXD2+) 9
RDB2(RXD2-) 11
MICROCOMPUTER
NC 13
CONNECTION
RSA(RTS+) 14
(ETHERNET)
NC 15
RSB(RTS-) 16
NC 17
CSA(CTS+) 18
NC 19 4
CSB(CTS-) 20
Some MODBUS®/RTU equipment doesn't have SG.In this case, the wiring between GOT and SG is unnecessary.
MODBUS(R)/RTU
*1
Some MODBUS®/RTU equipment require the control line (CS, RS, etc.) to be controlled. Make sure to connect the cables and
CONNECTION
*2
wires as described in the MODBUS®/RTU equipment manual.
*3 A terminating resistor is required. Set the terminating resistor selector of the main unit to "Disable" and connect a 110
terminating resistor. ( 1.4.3 Terminating resistors of GOT)
*4 For the terminating resistor of MODBUS®/RTU equipment, refer to the manual of MODBUS®/RTU equipment to be used.
*5 Use the twisted pair cable for SDA1/SDB1 and RDA1/RDB1.
5
RS-422/485 cable 1) (1 pair wiring)
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CON side(20 pin)*3 MODBUS®/RTU equipment side*1*2*4 MODBUS®/RTU equipment side*1*2*4
CONNECTION
SDA1(TXD1+)*5 (+) (+)
6
SDB1(TXD1-)*5 (-) (-)
8
RDA1(RXD1+)
10
R RDB1(RXD1-)
12
*3
SG 2
SG SG
6
NC 1
CONNECTION TO
NC 3
SOUND OUTPUT
NC 4
SDA2(TXD2+) 5
SDB2(TXD2-) 7
UNIT
RDA2(RXD2+) 9
RDB2(RXD2-) 11
NC
RSA(RTS+)
13
14
7
NC 15
CONNECTION TO
RSB(RTS-) 16
EXTERNAL I/O
NC 17
CSA(CTS+) 18
DEVICE
NC 19
CSB(CTS-) 20
*1 The actual terminal layout on the MODBUS®/RTU equipment may differ from the example shown above. SDA/B(+/-) and RDA/
B(+/-) terminals can be separated from each other. Make sure to connect the cables and wires as described in the MODBUS®/
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
*3 A terminating resistor is required. Set the terminating resistor selector of the main unit to "Disable" and connect a 110
FINGERPRINT
*1 Some MODBUS®/RTU equipment doesn't have SG.In this case, the wiring between GOT and SG is unnecessary.
*2 Some MODBUS®/RTU equipment require the control line (CS, RS, etc.) to be controlled.
Make sure to connect the cables and wires as described in the MODBUS®/RTU equipment manual.
*3 A terminating resistor is required. Set the terminating resistor selector of the main unit to "Disable" and connect a 330
terminating resistor. ( 1.4.3 Terminating resistors of GOT)
*4 For the terminating resistor of MODBUS®/RTU equipment, refer to the manual of MODBUS®/RTU equipment to be used.
*5 Use the twisted pair cable for SDA1/SDB1 and RDA1/RDB1.
Shell
*1 The actual terminal layout on the MODBUS®/RTU equipment may differ from the example shown above. SDA/B(+/-) and RDA/
B(+/-) terminals can be separated from each other. Make sure to connect the cables and wires as described in the MODBUS®/
RTU equipment manual.
*2 Some MODBUS®/RTU equipment doesn't have SG. In this case, the wiring between GOT and SG is unnecessary.
*3 A terminating resistor is required. Set the terminating resistor selector of the main unit to "Disable" and connect a 110
terminating resistor. ( 1.4.3 Terminating resistors of GOT)
*4 For the terminating resistor of MODBUS®/RTU equipment, refer to the manual of MODBUS®/RTU equipment to be used.
*5 Use the twisted pair cable for SDA1/SDB1.
PROCEDURES FOR
equipment equipment
GOT side (D-Sub 9-pin)*3 (1st) (2nd)
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
SDA RDA(+) RDA(+)
1
R SDB RDB(-) RDB(-)
6
*3 SDA(+) SDA(+)
RDA
2
R RDB SDB(-) SDB(-)
7
*3
SG 5
SG SG
2
RSA 3
MICROCOMPUTER
RSB 8
CONNECTION
CSA 4
CSB 9
(SERIAL)
*1 Some MODBUS®/RTU equipment doesn't have SG. In this case, the wiring between GOT and SG is unnecessary.
*2 Some MODBUS®/RTU equipment require the control line (CS, RS, etc.) to be controlled.
*3
Make sure to connect the cables and wires as described in the MODBUS®/RTU equipment manual.
A terminating resistor is required. For GT16, set the terminating resistor selector of the main unit to "Disable" and connect a
3
330 terminating resistor. For GT15, connect a 330 terminating resistor. ( 1.4.3 Terminating resistors of GOT)
MICROCOMPUTER
*4 For the terminating resistor of MODBUS®/RTU equipment, refer to the manual of MODBUS®/RTU equipment to be used.
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
RS422/485 cable 4) (2 pair wiring)
MODBUS®/RTU equipment side*1*2*4 MODBUS®/RTU equipment side*1*2*4
GOT side (D-Sub 9-pin)*3 (1st) (2nd)
4
RDA(+) RDA(+)
SDA 1
RDB(-) RDB(-)
SDB 6
SDA(+) SDA(+)
RDA 2
MODBUS(R)/RTU
SDB(-) SDB(-)
RDB
CONNECTION
7
SG SG
SG 5
RSA 3
RSB 8
CSA
5
4
CSB 9
®
*1 Some MODBUS /RTU equipment doesn't have SG. In this case, the wiring between GOT and SG is unnecessary.
MODBUS(R)/TCP
*2 Some MODBUS®/RTU equipment require the control line (CS, RS, etc.) to be controlled.
CONNECTION
Make sure to connect the cables and wires as described in the MODBUS®/RTU equipment manual.
*3 When placing the GOT to the terminal in the system configuration, set the terminating resistor to "330 ".
When placing the GOT to the position other than the terminal, set the terminating resistor of the GOT to "OPEN".
1.4.3 Terminating resistors of GOT
For the terminating resistor of MODBUS®/RTU equipment, refer to the manual of MODBUS®/RTU equipment to be used.
6
*4
RDA 2
RDB
SG
7
5
SG SG 7
RSA 3
CONNECTION TO
RSB 8
EXTERNAL I/O
CSA 4
CSB
DEVICE
*1 The actual terminal layout on the MODBUS®/RTU equipment may differ from the example shown above. SDA/B(+/-) and RDA/
B(+/-) terminals can be separated from each other. Make sure to connect the cables and wires as described in the MODBUS®/
RTU equipment manual. 8
*2 Some MODBUS®/RTU equipment doesn't have SG. In this case, the wiring between GOT and SG is unnecessary.
DEVICE CONNECTION
*3 When placing the GOT to the terminal in the system configuration, set the terminating resistor to "110 ".
AUTHENTICATION
When placing the GOT to the position other than the terminal, set the terminating resistor of the GOT to "OPEN".
FINGERPRINT
*1 Some MODBUS®/RTU equipment doesn't have SG. In this case, the wiring between GOT and SG is unnecessary.
*2 Some MODBUS®/RTU equipment require the control line (CS, RS, etc.) to be controlled.
Make sure to connect the cables and wires as described in the MODBUS®/RTU equipment manual.
*3 When placing the GOT to the terminal in the system configuration, set the terminating resistor to "330 ".
When placing the GOT to the position other than the terminal, set the terminating resistor of the GOT to "OPEN".
1.4.3 Terminating resistors of GOT
Set the 1pair/2pair signal selection switch to "1pair" when using the connection conversion adapter.
Connection Conversion Adapter User’s manual
*4 For the terminating resistor of MODBUS®/RTU equipment, refer to the manual of MODBUS®/RTU equipment.
RDA
RDB
SG SG
SG
*1 The actual terminal layout on the MODBUS®/RTU equipment may differ from the example shown above. SDA/B(+/-) and RDA/
B(+/-) terminals can be separated from each other. Make sure to connect the cables and wires as described in the MODBUS®/
RTU equipment manual.
*2 Some MODBUS®/RTU equipment doesn't have SG. In this case, the wiring between GOT and SG is unnecessary.
*3 When placing the GOT to the terminal in the system configuration, set the terminating resistor to "110 ".
When placing the GOT to the position other than the terminal, set the terminating resistor of the GOT to "OPEN".
1.4.3 Terminating resistors of GOT
Set the 1pair/2pair signal selection switch to "1pair" when using the connection conversion adapter.
Connection Conversion Adapter User’s manual
*4 For the terminating resistor of MODBUS®/RTU equipment, refer to the manual of MODBUS®/RTU equipment.
RSA
RSB
CSA
CSB
*1 Some MODBUS®/RTU equipment doesn't have SG. In this case, the wiring between GOT and SG is unnecessary.
*2 Some MODBUS®/RTU equipment require the control line (CS, RS, etc.) to be controlled.
Make sure to connect the cables and wires as described in the MODBUS®/RTU equipment manual.
*3 When placing the GOT to the terminal in the system configuration, set the terminating resistor to "330 ".
When placing the GOT to the position other than the terminal, set the terminating resistor of the GOT to "OPEN".
1.4.3 Terminating resistors of GOT
*4 For the terminating resistor of MODBUS®/RTU equipment, refer to the manual of MODBUS®/RTU equipment.
PROCEDURES FOR
MODBUS®/RTU equipment side*1*2*4 MODBUS®/RTU equipment side*1*2*4
*3 (1st) (2nd)
PREPARATORY
GOT side (D-Sub 9-pin)
MONITORING
(+) (+)
SDA 1
(-) (-)
SDB 6
RDA 2
RDB 7 2
SG SG
MICROCOMPUTER
SG 5
RSA 3
CONNECTION
RSB 8
(SERIAL)
CSA 4
CSB 9
*1 The actual terminal layout on the MODBUS®/RTU equipment may differ from the example shown above. SDA/B(+/-) and RDA/
3
B(+/-) terminals can be separated from each other. Make sure to connect the cables and wires as described in the MODBUS®/
MICROCOMPUTER
RTU equipment manual.
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
*2 Some MODBUS®/RTU equipment doesn't have SG.
In this case, the wiring between GOT and SG is unnecessary.
*3 When placing the GOT to the terminal in the system configuration, set the terminating resistor to "110 ".
When placing the GOT to the position other than the terminal, set the terminating resistor of the GOT to "OPEN".
4
1.4.3 Terminating resistors of GOT
*4 For the terminating resistor of MODBUS®/RTU equipment, refer to the manual of MODBUS®/RTU equipment.
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
MODBUS®/RTU equipment side*1*2*4 MODBUS®/RTU equipment side*1*2*4
GOT side (terminal block)*3 (1st) (2nd)
(+) (+)
SDA1 1
(-) (-)
SDB1 2
5
RDA1 3
MODBUS(R)/TCP
RDB1 4
CONNECTION
SG SG
SDA2 5
SDB2 6
RDA2 7
RDB2 8 6
SG 9
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
FG 10
*1 The actual terminal layout on the MODBUS®/RTU equipment may differ from the example shown above. SDA/B(+/-) and RDA/
B(+/-) terminals can be separated from each other. Make sure to connect the cables and wires as described in the MODBUS®/
UNIT
*4 For the terminating resistor of MODBUS®/RTU equipment, refer to the manual of MODBUS®/RTU equipment.
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
*1 The actual terminal layout on the MODBUS®/RTU equipment may differ from the example shown above. SDA/B(+/-) and RDA/
B(+/-) terminals can be separated from each other. Make sure to connect the cables and wires as described in the MODBUS®/
RTU equipment manual.
*2 Some MODBUS®/RTU equipment doesn't have SG.
In this case, the wiring between GOT and SG is unnecessary.
*3 For the terminating resistor of MODBUS®/RTU equipment, refer to the manual of MODBUS®/RTU equipment to be used.
*4 Set the 2-wire/4-wire terminating resistor setting switch of the RS-232/485 signal conversion adaptor as follows.
2-wire type/4-wire type: 4-wire type (2Pair)
<When placing GOT to the terminal>
Set the same terminating resistor value as that of MODBUS®/RTU equipment. However, only "110 "/"330 " can be set as the
terminating resistor of GOT.
If the terminating resistor value of MODBUS®/RTU equipment is other than "110 "/"330 ", set the terminating resistor of GOT
side to "OPEN" and install the terminating resistor set according to the terminating resistor value of MODBUS®/RTU equipment to
the RS-232/485 signal conversion adaptor externally.
<When placing GOT to other than the terminal>
Set the terminating resistor of the GOT to "OPEN".
1.4.4 Setting the RS-232/485 signal conversion adaptor
*5 Some MODBUS®/RTU equipment require the control line (CS, RS) to be controlled. In this case, the connection using the RS-
232/485 signal conversion adaptor is unavailable.
RDA
RDB
SG SG
SG
*1 The actual terminal layout on the MODBUS®/RTU equipment may differ from the example shown above. SDA/B(+/-) and RDA/
B(+/-) terminals can be separated from each other. Make sure to connect the cables and wires as described in the MODBUS®/
RTU equipment manual.
*2 Some MODBUS®/RTU equipment doesn't have SG.
In this case, the wiring between GOT and SG is unnecessary.
*3 For the terminating resistor of MODBUS®/RTU equipment, refer to the manual of MODBUS®/RTU equipment to be used.
*4 Set the 2-wire/4-wire terminating resistor setting switch of the RS-232/485 signal conversion adaptor as follows.
2-wire type/4-wire type: 2-wire type (1Pair)
<When placing GOT to the terminal>
Set the same terminating resistor value as that of MODBUS®/RTU equipment. However, only "110 "/"330 " can be set as the
terminating resistor of GOT.
If the terminating resistor value of MODBUS®/RTU equipment is other than "110 "/"330 ", set the terminating resistor of GOT
side to "OPEN" and install the terminating resistor set according to the terminating resistor value of MODBUS®/RTU equipment to
the RS-232/485 signal conversion adaptor externally.
<When placing GOT to other than the terminal>
Set the terminating resistor of the GOT to "OPEN".
1.4.4 Setting the RS-232/485 signal conversion adaptor
*5 Some MODBUS®/RTU equipment require the control line (CS, RS) to be controlled. In this case, the connection using the RS-
232/485 signal conversion adaptor is unavailable.
4 - 10 4. MODBUS(R)/RTU CONNECTION
4.3 Connection Diagram
1
Precautions when preparing a cable
PROCEDURES FOR
(1) Cable length
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
The length of the RS-422/485 cable must be 1200m or
less.
(2) GOT side connector
For the GOT side connector, refer to the following.
1.4.1 GOT connector specifications 2
MICROCOMPUTER
(3) MODBUS®/RTU equipment side connector
Use the connector compatible with the MODBUS®/RTU
CONNECTION
equipment side module.
(SERIAL)
For details, refer to the MODBUS equipment user's
manual.
MICROCOMPUTER
(1) GOT side
When connecting a MODBUS®/RTU equipment to the
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
GOT, a terminating resistor must be connected to the
GOT.
(a) For GT16 body, GT12, RS-422/485 communication
unit
Set the terminating resistor using the terminating 4
resistor setting switch.
MODBUS(R)/RTU
(b) For GT14, GT11, GT10
CONNECTION
Set the terminating resistor using the terminating
resistor selector.
For the procedure to set the terminating resistor, refer
to the following.
1.4.3 Terminating resistors of GOT
5
(2) MODBUS®/RTU equipment side
When connecting a MODBUS®/RTU equipment to the
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
GOT, a terminating resistor must be connected to the
MODBUS®/RTU equipment.
For details, refer to the MODBUS®/RTU equipment
user's manual.
6
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
4. MODBUS(R)/RTU CONNECTION 4 - 11
4.3 Connection Diagram
4.4 GOT Side Settings
4.4.1 Setting communication
4.4.2 Communication detail settings
interface (Communication
Make the settings according to the usage environment.
settings)
2.
3.
Item Description Range
Set this item when change the 9600bps,
transmission speed used for 19200bps,
4. Transmission
communication with the connected 38400bps,
Speed
equipment. 57600bps,
(Default: 19200bps) 115200bps
Set this item when change the data
length used for communication with
Data Bit 7bits/8bits
the connected equipment.
(Default: 8bits)
Click! Specify the stop bit length for
Stop Bit communications. 1bit/2bits
(Default: 1bit)
Specify whether or not to perform a
None
parity check, and how it is performed
Parity Even
1. Select [Common] [Controller Setting] from the during communication.
(Default: Even)
Odd
menu.
Set the number of retries to be
performed when a communication
2. The Controller Setting window is displayed. Select the Retry
error occurs.
0 to 5times
4 - 12 4. MODBUS(R)/RTU CONNECTION
4.4 GOT Side Settings
1
PROCEDURES FOR
HINT
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
If the communication with MODBUS®/RTU equipment
is not established, some equipment which requires a
delay longer than 3.5 character time may be
connected.
Adjust the send delay time in the communication detail 2
setting.
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
POINT
(SERIAL)
(1) Communication interface setting by the Utility
The communication interface setting can be
changed on the Utility's [Communication setting] 3
after writing [Communication Settings] of project
data.
MICROCOMPUTER
For details on the Utility, refer to the following
manual.
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
User's Manual of GOT used.
(2) Precedence in communication settings
When settings are made by GT Designer3 or the
Utility, the latest setting is effective.
4
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
5
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
6
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
4. MODBUS(R)/RTU CONNECTION 4 - 13
4.4 GOT Side Settings
4.5 MODBUS(R)/RTU Equipment Side Setting
Item Description
Set the device name, device number, and bit number.
The bit number can be set only when specifying the bit of word
Device device.
File Set the file No.
No. The file No. can be set only when select 6 at [Device].
Informati Displays the device type and setting range which are selected
on in [Device].
Set the station number of the controller to be monitored.
Host Select this item for monitoring the host controller.
Select this item for monitoring other
controllers.
After selecting the item, set the station
number and network number of the
For controller to be monitored.
GT16,
Other NW No.: For the MODBUS®/RTU
GT15,
connection, set "1".
GT14
For the MODBUS®/TCP
connection, set the
network No.
Network Station No.: Set the station No.
Select this item for monitoring other
controllers.
For
After selecting the item, set the station
GT11, Station No.
number of the controller to be
GT10
monitored.
Station No.: Set the station No.
Set the station No. to 0 to write data to all the
controllers connected.
Setting
During monitoring, the host controller is monitored.
of
(When writing the data in numerical input, the data is
station
written to all connected controllers during input, and
No. 0
the host controller is monitored during other than
input (displaying).)
4 - 14 4. MODBUS(R)/RTU CONNECTION
4.5 MODBUS(R)/RTU Equipment Side Setting
1
Address MODBUS communication control function on
PROCEDURES FOR
GT Designer3 converts the device numbers into the GS device
PREPARATORY
decimal format according to the address map of the
MONITORING
(1) Function overview
MODBUS®/RTU equipment to be used.
This function is to prevent the communication response
The table below shows the representations on the delay that occurs because the devices on the
MODBUS®/RTU communication protocol and GT MODBUS network differs from each other in network
Designer3. specification.
This function is effective for the MODBUS network
2
MODBUS/RTU Communication protocol
conditions as described below:
MICROCOMPUTER
Function code to be Representation on GT
• When only a part of function codes is supported
CONNECTION
Device name used Address Designer3
(Example: "0F" is not supported)
Read Write
• When the maximum transfer size of function code is
(SERIAL)
0000 000001
small (Example: The maximum number of coil read
0001 000002
0x05 times is 1000)
Coil 0x01 to to
0x0F
FFFE
FFFF
065535
065536
(2) Communication setting 3
When the MODBUS/RTU communication driver is
MICROCOMPUTER
0000 100001 assigned to multiple channel numbers using the multi-
0001 100002
channel function, the following cases are possible. The
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
Input relay 0x02 - to to
communication settings are shared between the
FFFE 165535
FFFF 165536
assigned multiple channel numbers, or the individual
communication setting is configured to a specific
0000 300001
0001 300002
channel number.
Input register 0x04 - to to By setting the device GS579, either the GS device used 4
FFFE 365535 for sharing communication settings (GS570 to GS576)
FFFF 365536 or the GS device used for individual communication
MODBUS(R)/RTU
0000 400001 setting (GS590 to GS617) is validated.
CONNECTION
0001 400002
Holding 0x06 GS
0x03 to to Description Set value
register 0x10 device
FFFE 465535
FFFF 465536 Bit0: 0 Configure the Ch1 communication
settings between GS570 to
Extension file
0000
0001
600000
600001 GS576. 5
0x14 0x15 to to 1 Configure the Ch1 communication
register settings between GS590 to
270E 609998
MODBUS(R)/TCP
270F 609999 GS596.
CONNECTION
Bit1: 0 Configure the Ch2 communication
settings between GS570 to
POINT 1
GS576.
Configure the Ch2 communication
settings between GS590 to
Address conversion example
GS579
Validity of
setting channel
GS603. 6
When monitoring the holding register's address Bit2: 0 Configure the Ch3 communication
number
"1234H", GT Designer3 displays "4*****" since GT settings between GS570 to
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
Designer3 processes the internal conversion in GS576.
decimal format as follows: 1 Configure the Ch3 communication
GT Designer3 converts the holding register's address settings between GS604 to
"1234H" to "04660" in decimal format. GS610
UNIT
Then, "+1" is added to this decimal address since the Bit3: 0 Configure the Ch4 communication
holding register's address on GT Designer3 always settings between GS570 to
starts from "1." GS576. 7
Therefore, the holding register's address "1234H" is 1 Configure the Ch4 communication
settings between GS611 to
displayed as "404661" on GT Designer3.
CONNECTION TO
GS617.
EXTERNAL I/O
"4 04660" +1 8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
"404661"
FINGERPRINT
4. MODBUS(R)/RTU CONNECTION 4 - 15
4.5 MODBUS(R)/RTU Equipment Side Setting
(a) When sharing communication settings between multiple channel numbers
The table below shows the settings for the GS device.
(b) When configuring individual communication settings for specific channel numbers
The table below shows the settings for the GS device.
GS device
Description Set value
Ch1 Ch2 Ch3 Ch4
Bit0: 0 Using Function Code "0F"
1 Not using Function Code "0F"
GS590 GS597 GS604 GS611 Command selection
Bit1: 0 Using Function Code "10"
1 Not using Function Code "10"
Function Code "01" 0:2000
GS591 GS598 GS605 GS612 Specification for the max. number of 1 to 2000: Specify the maximum number.
coil read times Other than above: 2000
Function Code "02" 0:2000
GS592 GS599 GS606 GS613 Specification for the max. number of 1 to 2000: Specify the maximum number.
input relay read times Other than above: 2000
Function Code "03" 0:125
GS593 GS600 GS607 GS614 Specification for the max. number of 1 to 125: Specify the maximum number.
holding register read times Other than above: 125
Function Code "04" 0:125
GS594 GS601 GS608 GS615 Specification for the max. number of 1 to 125: Specify the maximum number.
input register read times Other than above: 125
0:800
Function Code "0F" 1 to 1968: Specify the maximum number.
GS595 GS602 GS609 GS616 Specification for the max. number of Other than above: 1968
multiple-coil write times When Bit0 of GS570 is "1", the function code "0F" is not
used, and therefore the setting of GS575 will be disabled.
0:100
Function Code "10" 1 to 123: Specify the maximum number.
GS596 GS603 GS610 GS617 Specification for the max. number of Other than above: 123
multiple-holding register write times When Bit1 of GS570 is "1", the function code "10F" is not
used, and therefore the setting of GS576 will be disabled.
4 - 16 4. MODBUS(R)/RTU CONNECTION
4.5 MODBUS(R)/RTU Equipment Side Setting
4.5.2 Station number setting 1
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
In the MODBUS network, a maximum of 31 MODBUS®/
MONITORING
RTU equipment can be connected to one GOT.
Assign a non-overlapped station number ranging from 1 to
247 arbitrarily to each MODBUS®/RTU equipment.
In the system configuration, the MODBUS®/RTU 2
equipment with the station number set with the host
MICROCOMPUTER
address must be included.
The station number can be set without regard to the cable
CONNECTION
connection order. There is no problem even if station
(SERIAL)
numbers are not consecutive.
Station Station Station
GOT No.3 No.15 No.1
3
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
Examples of station number setting
MODBUS(R)/RTU
Specification range
CONNECTION
1 to 247
MODBUS(R)/TCP
When specifying the station No. from 248 to 254 on GT
CONNECTION
Designer3, the value of GD10 to GD16 compatible to
the station No. specification will be the station No. of
the MODBUS®/RTU equipment.
Specification Compatible
station NO. device
Setting range 6
248 GD10
CONNECTION TO
0 to 255:
SOUND OUTPUT
249 GD11
250 GD12 0 : All station specification (broadcast)
255 : Host station access
251 GD13
For the setting other than the above, an
252 GD14
UNIT
error (dedicated device is out of range) will
253 GD15 occur.
254 GD16
7
(3) All station specification (broadcast)
Target station differs depending on write-in operation or
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
read-out operation.
• For write-in operation, all station will be a target.
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
4. MODBUS(R)/RTU CONNECTION 4 - 17
4.5 MODBUS(R)/RTU Equipment Side Setting
4.6 Precautions
Reading the holding registers MODBUS communication control function on
The GOT reads the holding registers (400001) for the GS device
checking whether the GOT can communicate with the At GOT startup, set MODBUS communication control
controller. function with project scripts, etc.
Therefore, if the equipment does not have holding If settings are changed after communication start, a
registers (400001), normal communication may not be communication error may occur.
performed.
4 - 18 4. MODBUS(R)/RTU CONNECTION
4.6 Precautions
5
1
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
2
MICROCOMPUTER
MODBUS(R)/TCP CONNECTION
CONNECTION
(SERIAL)
5.
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
5.1 Connectable Model List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 2
4
5.2 System Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 2
MODBUS(R)/RTU
5.3 GOT Side Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 3
CONNECTION
5.4 MODBUS(R)/TCP Equipment Setting . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 6
5.5 Device Range that Can Be Set . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 6
5.6 Example of Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 10 5
5.7 Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 - 15
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
6
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
5-1
5. MODBUS(R)/TCP CONNECTION
MODBUS®/TCP
Hub GOT
equipment
Connection cable Connection cable
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
5.3.1 Setting communication
5.3.2 Communication detail settings
interface (Communication
settings) Make the settings according to the usage environment.
(1) GT16, GT14 2
Set the channel of the equipment to be connected to the
MICROCOMPUTER
GOT.
CONNECTION
2.
(SERIAL)
3
3.
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
4.
MODBUS(R)/RTU
GOT PLC Set the station No. of the GOT.
1 to 247
CONNECTION
No.*2 (Default: 1)
GOT Set the IP address of the GOT. 0.0.0.0 to
IP Address*1 (Default: 192.168.3.18) 255.255.255.255
Subnet Mask*1
router) 0.0.0.0 to 5
If the sub network is not used, the 255.255.255.255
1. Select [Common] [Controller Setting] from the default value is set.
MODBUS(R)/TCP
menu. (Default: 255.255.255.0)
CONNECTION
Set the router address of the
2. The Controller Setting window is displayed. Select the Default default gateway where the GOT is
0.0.0.0 to
channel to be used from the list menu. Gateway connected.(Only for connection via
255.255.255.255
*1 router)
3. Set the following items. (Default: 0.0.0.0)
6
• Manufacturer: MODBUS 1024 to 5010,
Ethernet Set the GOT port No. for Ethernet 5014 to 65534
• Controller Type: MODBUS
CONNECTION TO
Download Port download. (Except for 5011,
SOUND OUTPUT
• I/F: Interface to be used
No.*1 (Default: 5014) 5012, 5013 and
• Driver: MODBUS/TCP, Gateway 49153)
1024 to 5010,
4. The detailed setting is displayed after Manufacturer, Set the GOT port No. for the
UNIT
Delay Time
confirmed in [I/F Communication Setting].For details, PLC. ( 10 ms)
AUTHENTICATION
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
Changing the host with GOT module (GT16, GT14
only)
The host can be changed by the GOT module Utility.
For details of settings, refer to the following.
GT16 User's Manual (Basic Utility) 2
GT14 User's Manual
MICROCOMPUTER
(For GT16)
CONNECTION
(SERIAL)
Item Description Range
The host is displayed.(The host is
Host
indicated with an asterisk (*).)
―
3
Set the network No. of the
MICROCOMPUTER
N/W No. connected Ethernet module. 1 to 239
(Default: blank)
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
Set the station No. of the
PLC No.*2 connected Ethernet module. 1 to 247
(Default: blank)
MODBUS/TCP
Type*1 MODBUS/TCP (fixed)
(fixed)
4
Set the IP address of the
PLC side IP
IP Address connected Ethernet module.
address
MODBUS(R)/RTU
(Default: blank)
CONNECTION
Set the port No. of the connected
Port No. Ethernet module. 1 to 65535
(Default: 502)
Communication
TCP (fixed) TCP (fixed)
format
5
*1 Select [MODBUS/TCP] for [Controller Type].
For the applicable Ethernet module, refer to the following.
MODBUS(R)/TCP
5.2 System Configuration
CONNECTION
*2 Each of [GOT PLC No.] set in the communication detail
setting and [PLC No.] set in the Ethernet setting must be set
to different station numbers.
5.3.2 Communication detail settings
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
Setting item
Item Description
Information Displays the device type and setting range which are selected in [Device].
PROCEDURES FOR
representation
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
Coils (0) 000001 to 065536
Bit device
Decimal
MICROCOMPUTER
Decimal
File No.: 0 to104
CONNECTION
Extension file register (6)
600000 to 609999
(SERIAL)
*1 Only reading is possible.
POINT 3
MICROCOMPUTER
(1) Range of coils and input relays that can be monitored
The device range of MODBUS equipment differs depending on the type.
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
When using types that the device range for coils and input relays are other than hexadecimal, monitoring to
the device maximum range may not be possible.
In this case, the device range extends to the last number divisible by 16.
Example: For a type whose coil device range is from 0 to 9999.
The range that can be actually monitored is from 0 to 9984. 4
(2) Address conversion example
MODBUS(R)/RTU
When monitoring the holding register's address "1234H", GT Designer3 displays "4*****" since GT Designer3
CONNECTION
processes the internal conversion in decimal format as follows:
GT Designer3 converts the holding register's address "1234H" to "04660" in decimal format.
Then, "+1" is added to this decimal address since the holding register's address on GT Designer3 always
starts from "1."
Therefore, the holding register's address "1234H" is displayed as "404661" on GT Designer3. 5
Holding register 1234H
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
"4 04660" +1
6
"404661"
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
For details of GS devices (GS570 to GS576) and GS devices (GS590 to GS617), refer to the next page.
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
GS device Description Set value
MONITORING
Bit0: 0 Using Function Code "0F"
1 Not using Function Code "0F"
GS570 Command selection
Bit1: 0 Using Function Code "10"
1 Not using Function Code "10"
GS571
Function Code "01"
Specification for the max. number of
0:1000
1 to 2000: Specify the maximum number. 2
coil read times Other than above: 2000
MICROCOMPUTER
Function Code "02" 0:1000
CONNECTION
GS572 Specification for the max. number of 1 to 2000: Specify the maximum number.
input relay read times Other than above: 2000
(SERIAL)
Function Code "03" 0:125
GS573 Specification for the max. number of 1 to 125: Specify the maximum number.
holding register read times Other than above: 125
Function Code "04" 0:125 3
GS574 Specification for the max. number of 1 to 125: Specify the maximum number.
MICROCOMPUTER
input register read times Other than above: 125
0:800
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
Function Code "0F" 1 to 800: Specify the maximum number.
GS575 Specification for the max. number of Other than above: 800
multiple-coil write times When Bit0 of GS570 is "1", the function code "0F" is not used,
and therefore the setting of GS575 will be disabled.
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
used, and therefore the setting of GS576 will be disabled.
(b) When configuring individual communication settings for specific channel numbers
The table below shows the settings for the GS device.
GS device
Ch1 Ch2 Ch3 Ch4
Description Set value
5
Bit0: 0 Using Function Code "0F"
1 Not using Function Code "0F"
MODBUS(R)/TCP
GS590 GS597 GS604 GS611 Command selection
Bit1: 0 Using Function Code "10"
CONNECTION
1 Not using Function Code "10"
Function Code "01" 0:1000
GS591 GS598 GS605 GS612 Specification for the max. number of 1 to 2000: Specify the maximum number.
coil read times Other than above: 2000
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
Function Code "03" 0:125
GS593 GS600 GS607 GS614 Specification for the max. number of 1 to 125: Specify the maximum number.
holding register read times Other than above: 125
Function Code "04" 0:125
UNIT
GS594 GS601 GS608 GS615 Specification for the max. number of 1 to 125: Specify the maximum number.
input register read times Other than above: 125
0:800
7
Function Code "0F" 1 to 800: Specify the maximum number.
CONNECTION TO
GS595 GS602 GS609 GS616 Specification for the max. number of Other than above: 800
EXTERNAL I/O
multiple-coil write times When Bit0 of GS570 is "1", the function code "0F" is not
used, and therefore the setting of GS575 will be disabled.
DEVICE
0:100
Function Code "10" 1 to 100: Specify the maximum number.
GS596 GS603 GS610 GS617 Specification for the max. number of Other than above: 100
multiple-holding register write times When Bit1 of GS570 is "1", the function code "10F" is not
used, and therefore the setting of GS576 will be disabled.
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
System Configuration
Communication driver
MODBUS/TCP
SCHNEIDER Ethernet
Hub GOT
PLC module
Connection cable Connection cable
POINT
SCHNEIDER ELECTRIC PLC
For details of SCHNEIDER PLC, refer to the following manual.
SCHNEIDER PLC user's Manual
5 - 10 5. MODBUS(R)/TCP CONNECTION
5.6 Example of Connection
(1) Parameter settings
1
PROCEDURES FOR
Set the parameter settings with programming software for SCHNEIDER PLC.
PREPARATORY
(a) For Modicon Premium series
MONITORING
Set for PL7 Pro programming software.
MICROCOMPUTER
IP Address IP address for Ethernet module
CONNECTION
Setting for device points
Size of global address
Bits: Coil, Input
(SERIAL)
fields
Words: Input register, Maintenance register
MICROCOMPUTER
Item Set value
CONNECTION
PLC Selection Connected CPU module
(ETHERNET)
TCP/IP Ethernet Numbers of unit
I/O Module Selection Connected Ethernet module
Internet Address IP address for Ethernet module
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
5
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
6
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
5. MODBUS(R)/TCP CONNECTION 5 - 11
5.6 Example of Connection
5.6.2 Connecting to YOKOGAWA PLC (STARDOM)
System Configuration
Communication driver
MODBUS/TCP
YOKOGAWA
PLC Hub GOT
POINT
Connection between STARDOM and the PC for communication settings
For the communication settings of STARDOM, STARDOM and the PC for communication settings must be
connected to Ethernet using the Resource Configurator (peripheral software).
5 - 12 5. MODBUS(R)/TCP CONNECTION
5.6 Example of Connection
(1) Modbus Communication Portfolio License
1
PROCEDURES FOR
To set the communication settings for STARDOM, an installation of Modbus Communication Portfolio License is
required.
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
For details of the communication settings, refer to the following manual.
STARDOM FCN/FCJ Guide
(2) Defining Logic POU
Define Logic POU using Logic Designer (peripheral software), and download the project to STARDOM. 2
(a) Start Logic Designer and create a new project using a template.
MICROCOMPUTER
Use [STARDOM Serial Communication] template.
CONNECTION
(b) Insert Firmware Library to the new project.
• Right-click [Library] under the project tree in Logic Designer.
(SERIAL)
• Right-click [Insert] and select [Firmware Library].
• Double-click the [SD_FCXPLCE_LIB] folder and double-click [SD_FCXPLCE_LIB.fwl] to select it.
• The library path inserted in the procedures above is as follows.
{Install Folder}\LogicDesigner\Mwt\Plc\Fw_lib\SD_FCXPLCE_LIB\SD_FCXPLCE_LIB.fwl
3
MICROCOMPUTER
(c) Insert User Library to the new project.
• Right-click [Library] under the project tree in Logic Designer.
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
• Right-click [Insert] and select [User Library].
• Double-click [SD_CMODBUSE_PF.mwt], [SD_CUTIL_PF.mwt] and [SD_CMODBUSS_PF.mwt] to
select it.
(When [STARDOM Serial Communication] is used for the template, [SD_CUTIL_PF.mwt] is inserted as
default.) 4
• The library path inserted in the procedures above is as follows.
MODBUS(R)/RTU
{Install Folder}\LogicDesigner\Libraries\SD_CMODBUSE_PF.mwt
CONNECTION
{Install Folder}\LogicDesigner\Libraries\SD_CUTIL_PF.mwt
{Install Folder}\LogicDesigner\Libraries\SD_CMODBUSS_PF.mwt
(d) Copy a sample project POU to the new project.
• Open "SD_CMODBUSE_Sample1.mwt".
• Right-click [ComEServerModbus*] in the Logic POU under the project tree in the 5
SD_CMODBUSE_Sample1 project, and select [Copy].
• Right-click the [Logic POU] under the project tree in the previously created project, and select [Paste].
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
• Double-click the [ComEServerModbus*] file in the [ComEServerModbus*] folder.
• For the following terminals, set as shown below.
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
5. MODBUS(R)/TCP CONNECTION 5 - 13
5.6 Example of Connection
(e) Set devices to be monitored by a GOT.
• Right-click the [ComEServerModbus*] file in the [ComEServerModbus*] folder in the logic POU under
the project tree and select [Insert] - [Cord worksheet].
• Set the variable devices to be monitored.
Instantiate Logic POU.Define an already defined instance to Task0.
• Right-click [Physical hardware] - [Configuration:IPC_33/FCX01:FCX/Tasks/Task0:CYCLIC] and select
[Insert] - [Program instance].
• Define the program instance name and select ComEServerModbus for the program type.
(f) Defining Target Setting
Define the IP address of STARDOM to set the communication settings.
Double-click [Physical hardware] - [Configuration:IPC_33/FCX01:FCX/Target Setting] and input the IP
address or the host name.
(g) Downloading the project
• Execute [Build] - [Make].
(Same as when pressing the function key F9).
• Download after confirming that the compile error does not occur. Select [Download] in the project control
dialog displayed when [Online] - [Project control] is selected.
• When the download is completed, select [Cold] and start STARDOM.
Device range
When performing monitoring with the GOT connected to a YOKOGAWA PLC and setting devices for objects, use
devices within the device range of the YOKOGAWA PLC.
When a device outside the range is set on an object, an indefinite value is displayed on the object.
(No error is displayed in the system alarm.)
For details on the device range of YOKOGAWA PLCs, refer to the following manual:
YOKOGAWA PLC user's Manual
Precautions
(1) For dual-redundant configuration
When STARDOM is configured with a redundant system, the connection is not supported.
(2) Not communicating with GOT and STARDOM in a specified period
When the GOT does not communicate with STARDOM in a specified period during the GOT is turned on,
STARDOM disconnects the line for the GOT. As the line is disconnected, the GOT displays an error when the
GOT monitors STARDAM after the disconnection.
After the error displayed as the system alarm (No.402: timeout error) on the GOT, the normal communication is
recovered and the GOT can monitor STARDOM.
5 - 14 5. MODBUS(R)/TCP CONNECTION
5.6 Example of Connection
1
5.7 Precautions
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
When connecting to multiple GOTs MODBUS communication control function on
the GS device
(1) Setting PLC No.
At GOT startup, set MODBUS communication control
When connecting two or more GOTs in the MODBUS®/
function with project scripts, etc.
2
TCP network, set each [PLC No.] to the GOT.
If settings are changed after communication start, a
MICROCOMPUTER
5.3.1 Setting communication interface communication error may occur.
(Communication settings)
CONNECTION
(2) Setting IP address
(SERIAL)
Do not use the IP address "192.168.0.18" when using
multiple GOTs.
A communication error may occur on the GOT with the
IP address.
3
MICROCOMPUTER
When setting IP address
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
Do not use "0" and "255" at the end of an IP address.
(Numbers of *.*.*.0 and *.*.*.255 are used by the
system)
The GOT may not monitor the controller correctly with
the above numbers.
4
Consult with the administrator of the network before
MODBUS(R)/RTU
setting an IP address to the GOT and controller.
CONNECTION
When connecting to the multiple network
equipment (including GOT) in a segment
By increasing the network load, the transmission speed
between the GOT and PLC may be reduced. Setting example for project script
5
The following actions may improve the communication
MODBUS(R)/TCP
performance.
CONNECTION
• Using a switching hub
• More high speed by 100BASE-TX (100Mbps)
• Reduction of the monitoring points on GOT
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
5. MODBUS(R)/TCP CONNECTION 5 - 15
5.7 Precautions
5 - 16 5. MODBUS(R)/TCP CONNECTION
5.7 Precautions
CONNECTIONS TO PERIPHERAL
EQUIPMENT
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
2
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION TO SOUND
CONNECTION
(SERIAL)
6.
OUTPUT UNIT 3
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
4
6.1 Connectable Model List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 - 2
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
6.2 System Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 - 2
6.3 GOT Side Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 - 3
6.4 Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 - 4 5
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
6
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
6-1
6. CONNECTION TO SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
Connection type
Sound output dependent
Connection cable
HINT
System configuration between the GOT and PLC
For the system configuration between the GOT and PLC, refer to each chapter.
Mitsubishi Electric Products
Non-Mitsubishi Electric Products 1, Non-Mitsubishi Electric Products 2
Microcomputer, MODBUS Products, Peripherals
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
6.3.1 Setting communication
interface Sound output unit setting
Controller setting 2. 2
Set the channel of the equipment to be connected to
MICROCOMPUTER
the GOT.
CONNECTION
2.
(SERIAL)
Click!
3
3.
MICROCOMPUTER
1. Select [Common] [Peripheral Setting]
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
[Sound Output] from the menu.
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
POINT
Click! (1) Communication interface setting by the Utility
The communication interface setting can be
changed on the Utility's [Communication setting]
after writing [Communication Settings] of project
5
data.
1. Select [Common] [Controller Setting] from the
MODBUS(R)/TCP
For details on the Utility, refer to the following
CONNECTION
menu. manual.
2. The Controller Setting window is displayed. Select the User's Manual of GOT used.
channel to be used from the list menu. (2) Precedence in communication settings
When settings are made by GT Designer3 or the
3. Set Manufacturer, Controller Type, I/F, and Driver Utility, the latest setting is effective. 6
according to the connected equipment to be used.
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
4. The detailed setting is displayed after Manufacturer,
Controller Type, I/F, and Driver are set.
Make the settings according to the usage
UNIT
environment.
POINT
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
2
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION TO EXTERNAL I/O
CONNECTION
(SERIAL)
7.
DEVICE 3
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
4
7.1 Connectable Model List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 2
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
7.2 System Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 2
7.3 Connection Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 4
7.4 GOT Side Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 12 5
7.5 Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 - 13
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
6
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
7-1
7. CONNECTION TO EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
Connection cable
DC power supply
*1 The power supply of 24VDC must be applied for the external I/O unit.
When the power supply of the external I/O unit is stopped in the operation, the operation panel becomes nonfunctional.
For using the operation panel again, reset the GOT after supplying the power to the external I/O unit.
*2 When starting, turn on the external power supply to the external I/O unit and turn on the GOT.
When turning off the external power supply, a system alarm occurs.
When a system alarm is generated, input/output cannot be performed.
In this case, turn on the main power of the GOT or reset the GOT.
(When bus connection is used, the reset switch on the GOT does not function.)
PROCEDURES FOR
Extended function OS
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
External I/O /Operation panel
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(SERIAL)
Operation panel
Connector/terminal
Connection cable 1) block convertor
module
GOT 3
Connection cable 2)
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
General output device Connection cable 1)
(ETHERNET)
(Lamp, relay)
DC power supply
4
Connection cable 1) Connection cable 2) GOT*3
MODBUS(R)/RTU
Connector/terminal block converter
Connection diagram Connection diagram
CONNECTION
Name module*1*2 Option device Model
number number
Connection A6TBY36-E
diagram 7) Connection diagram 7)
General input device Connection
GT15-DIO
(Push button, etc.) Connection
diagram 8)
A6TBY54-E
Connection diagram 8)
diagram 5)
5
Operation panel
Connection A6TBY36-E
MODBUS(R)/TCP
General output device diagram 9) Connection diagram 9)
CONNECTION
Connection
(Lamp, relay) GT15-DIOR
Connection A6TBY54-E diagram 6)
diagram 10) Connection diagram 10)
*1 The power supply of 24VDC must be applied for the external I/O unit.
When the power supply of the external I/O unit is stopped in the operation, the operation panel becomes nonfunctional.
For using the operation panel again, reset the GOT after supplying the power to the external I/O unit. 6
*2 When the connector/terminal block converter module is used, the maximum input points are 64 points.
*3 When starting, turn on the external power supply to the external I/O unit and turn on the GOT.
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
When turning off the external power supply, a system alarm occurs.
When a system alarm is generated, input/output cannot be performed.
In this case, turn on the main power of the GOT or reset the GOT.
(When bus connection is used, the reset switch on the GOT does not function.)
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
The connection cable between the external I/O unit and the XD02
XD03
operation panel must be prepared by the user referring to XD04
the followings. XD05
XD06
XD07
For GT15-DIO XD08
XD09
Connection diagram 1) XD0A
XD0B
External I/O unit side Original operation panel XD0C
XD0D
XD00 18 XD00 XD0E
XD01 43 XD01 XD0F
XD02 19 XD02
XSCN00
XD03 44 XD03
XSCN01
XD04 20 XD04 XSCN02
XD05 45 XD05 XSCN03
XD06 21 XD06 XSCN04
XSCN05
XD07 46 XD07
XSCN06
XD08 22 XD08 XSCN07
XD09 47 XD09
XD0A 23 XD0A
XD0B 48 XD0B
For 128-point input*1
XD0C 24 XD0C
XD0D 49 XD0D X070 X060 X050 X040 X030 X020 X010 X000
XD00
XD0E 25 XD0E X001
XD0F 50 XD0F XD01
X002
XSCN00 14 XSCN00 XD02
XSCN01 39 XSCN01 X003
XD03
XSCN02 15 XSCN02 X004
XD04
XSCN03 40 XSCN03 X005
XD05
XSCN04 16 XSCN04
X006
XSCN05 41 XSCN05 XD06
X007
XSCN06 17 XSCN06 XD07
XSCN07 42 XSCN07 X008
XD08
YD00 6 X009
XD09
YD01 31 X00A
XD0A
YD02 7
X00B
XD0B
YD03 32
X00C
YD04 8 XD0C
X00D
YD05 33 XD0D
YD06 9 X00E
XD0E
YD07 34 X00F
XD0F
YD08 10
YD09 35
YD0A 11 XSCN00
YD0B 36 XSCN01
YD0C 12 XSCN02
YD0D 37
Cable for connecting an external XSCN03
YD0E 13
input power supply XSCN04
YD0F 38
RUN 30 XSCN05
DC24V 4 XSCN06
DC24V 3 XSCN07
DC24V 2 DC24V
*2
DC24V 1
COM 29
COM 28
COM 27 *1 The 128-point input can be executed with using a 16-point
COM 26 input signal (XD00 to XD0F) with an 8-point scan signal
N.C. 5 (XSCN00 to XSCN07).
*2 When two or more switches are pressed simultaneously, be
sure to put the diode to each switch. (Only for 128-point
input)
PROCEDURES FOR
For 16-point input
Connection diagram 3)
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
XD00
External I/O unit side Original operation panel XD01
XD02
XD00 18 XD00
XD03
XD01 43 XD01 XD04
XD02 19 XD02 XD05
2
XD03 44 XD03 XD06
XD07
XD04 20 XD04
XD08
XD05 45 XD05 XD09
MICROCOMPUTER
XD06 21 XD06 XD0A
XD07 XD07 XD0B
CONNECTION
46
XD0C
XD08 22 XD08 XD0D
(SERIAL)
XD09 47 XD09 XD0E
XD0A 23 XD0A XD0F
XD0B 48 XD0B
XSCN00
XD0C XD0C
3
24
XSCN01
XD0D 49 XD0D XSCN02
XD0E 25 XD0E XSCN03
MICROCOMPUTER
XSCN04
XD0F 50 XD0F
XSCN05
XSCN00 14 XSCN00
CONNECTION
XSCN06
(ETHERNET)
XSCN01 39 XSCN01 XSCN07
XSCN02 15 XSCN02
XSCN03 40 XSCN03
XSCN04 16 XSCN04 For 128-point input*1
XSCN05 41 XSCN05
XSCN06
XSCN07
17
42
XSCN06
XSCN07
X070 X060 X050 X040 X030 X020 X010 X000
XD00
4
X001
XD01
YD00 6
MODBUS(R)/RTU
X002
YD01 31 XD02
CONNECTION
X003
YD02 7 XD03
YD03 32 X004
XD04
YD04 8 X005
XD05
YD05 33
X006
XD06
YD06 9
5
X007
YD07 34 XD07
X008
YD08 10 XD08
YD09 35 X009
XD09
MODBUS(R)/TCP
YD0A 11 X00A
XD0A
CONNECTION
YD0B 36 X00B
XD0B
YD0C 12
X00C
YD0D 37 XD0C
YD0E 13 Cable for connecting an external X00D
XD0D
input power supply
YD0F 38 X00E
XD0E
RUN
DC24V
30
4
X00F
XD0F 6
DC24V 3
CONNECTION TO
DC24V 2 DC24V XSCN00
SOUND OUTPUT
DC24V 1 XSCN01
0V 29 XSCN02
0V 28
XSCN03
0V 27
UNIT
XSCN04
0V 26
N.C. XSCN05
7
5
XSCN06
XSCN07
CONNECTION TO
*2
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
input)
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
The connection cable between the external I/O unit and the
connector/terminal block converter module must be
prepared by the user referring to the followings.
PROCEDURES FOR
Connection diagram 6)
PREPARATORY
1) 2) 5) 3) 4)
MONITORING
External I/O unit side Terminal block converter side
MICROCOMPUTER
XD05 45 A18 XD05
XD06 21 B17 XD06
CONNECTION
XD07 46 A17 XD07
XD08
(SERIAL)
22
XD09 47
XD0A 23 No. Name Model name Manufacturer
XD0B 48
XD0C 24
PCR-E50FS+
(GT15-DIO)
3
XD0D 49 1) Connector
PCS-E50FS+ Honda Tsushin Kogyo
MICROCOMPUTER
XD0E 25
XD0F 50 (GT15-DIOR) Co., Ltd.
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
XSCN00 14 B16 XSCN00 Connector
2) PCS-E50LA
XSCN01 39 A16 XSCN01 cover
XSCN02 15 B15 XSCN02 3) Connector Mitsubishi Electric
XSCN03 40 A15 XSCN03 A6CON1
4) (with a cover) Corporation
XSCN04 16 B14 XSCN04
XSCN05 41 A14 XSCN05 5) Connector FCN-361J040-AU
FUJITSU 4
XSCN06 17 B13 XSCN06 Connector COMPONENT LIMITED
6) FCN-360C040-B
XSCN07 42 A13 XSCN07 cover
MODBUS(R)/RTU
YD00 6 B12 YD00 UL 2464 AWG28 or
CONNECTION
YD01 31 A12 YD01 7) Cable ───
equivalent
YD02 7 B11 YD02
YD03 32 A11 YD03
YD04
YD05
8
33
B10
A10
YD04
YD05
Precautions when preparing a cable
YD06
YD07
9 B9 YD06
YD07
(1) Cable length 5
34 A9
Maximum cable length differs depending on the cable
YD08 10 B8 YD08
used. Make the cable length within the range that can
MODBUS(R)/TCP
YD09 35 A8 YD09
CONNECTION
YD0A 11 B7 YD0A satisfy the I/O specifications of the external I/O unit.
YD0B 36 A7 YD0B
YD0C 12 B6 YD0C (2) GOT side connector
YD0D 37 A6 YD0D For the GOT side connector, refer to the following.
YD0E 13 B5 YD0E 1.4.1 GOT connector specifications
YD0F
RUN
38
30
A5 YD0F 6
DC24V 4 B4 24V
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
DC24V 3 A4 24V
DC24V 2 B3 24V
DC24V 1
0V 29 A3 0V
UNIT
0V 28 B2 0V
0V 27 A2 Empty
0V
N.C.
26
5
B1
A1
Empty
Empty
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
The connection cable among the original operation panel, the connector/terminal block converter module and the
general output device must be prepared by the user referring to the followings.
For GT15-DIO
Connection diagram 7)
When using A6TBY36-E connector/terminal block module
24V
0V
B20 XD00
A20 XD01
B19 XD02
A19 XD03
B18 XD04
A18 XD05
B17 XD06
A17 XD07
B16 XSCN0
A16 XSCN1
B15 XSCN2
A15 XSCN3
B14 XSCN4
A14 XSCN5
B13 XSCN6
A13 XSCN7
B12 YD00 A6TBY36-E
A12 YD01
B11 YD02
A11 YD03
B10 YD04
A10 YD05
B9 YD06
A9 YD07
B8 YD08
A8 YD09
B7 YD0A
A7 YD0B
B6 YD0C
A6 YD0D
B5 YD0E
A5 YD0F
B4 24V
A4 24V
B3 24V
A3 0V
B2 0V
A2
B1
A1
10 12 14 16 18 1A 1C 1E 24V
11 13 15 17 19 1B 1D 1F 0V
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
PROCEDURES FOR
When using A6TBY54-E connector/terminal block module
PREPARATORY
User-created original operation panel
MONITORING
XD00 XD01 XD02 XD03 XD04 XD05 XD06 XD07
70 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 XSCN07
60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 XSCN06
50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 XSCN05
40
30
41
31
42
32
43
33
44
34
45
35
46
36
47
37
XSCN04 2
XSCN03
MICROCOMPUTER
20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 XSCN02
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 XSCN01
CONNECTION
00 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 XSCN00
(SERIAL)
3
-C -C -C -C -C 0V
MICROCOMPUTER
-C -C -C -C 24V
B20 XD00
CONNECTION
A20 XD01
(ETHERNET)
B19 XD02
A19 XD03
B18 XD04
A18 XD05
B17 XD06
A17
B16
XD07
XSCN0
4
A16 XSCN1
B15 XSCN2
MODBUS(R)/RTU
A15 XSCN3
CONNECTION
B14 XSCN4
A14 XSCN5
B13 XSCN6
A13 XSCN7
B12 YD00 A6TBY54-E
A12 YD01
B11
A11
YD02
YD03
5
B10 YD04
MODBUS(R)/TCP
A10 YD05
B9 YD06
CONNECTION
A9 YD07
B8 YD08
A8 YD09
B7 YD0A
A7 YD0B
B6
A6
YD0C
YD0D 6
B5 YD0E
A5 YD0F
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
B4 24V
A4 24V
B3 24V
A3 0V
B2 0V
UNIT
A2
B1
A1
10 -C 12 14 -C 16 18 -C 1A 1C -C 1E -C 0V
7
11 -C 13 15 -C 17 19 -C 1B 1D -C 1F 24V
CONNECTION TO
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
EXTERNAL I/O
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
24V
0V
B20 XD00
A20 XD01
B19 XD02
A19 XD03
B18 XD04
A18 XD05
B17 XD06
A17 XD07
B16 XSCN0
A16 XSCN1
B15 XSCN2
A15 XSCN3
B14 XSCN4
A14 XSCN5
B13 XSCN6
A13 XSCN7
B12 YD00 A6TBY36-E
A12 YD01
B11 YD02
A11 YD03
B10 YD04
A10 YD05
B9 YD06
A9 YD07
B8 YD08
A8 YD09
B7 YD0A
A7 YD0B
B6 YD0C
A6 YD0D
B5 YD0E
A5 YD0F
B4 24V
A4 24V
B3 24V
A3 0V
B2 0V
A2
B1
A1
10 12 14 16 18 1A 1C 1E 24V
11 13 15 17 19 1B 1D 1F 0V
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
PROCEDURES FOR
When using A6TBY54-E connector/terminal block module
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
XD00 XD01 XD02 XD03 XD04 XD05 XD06 XD07
70 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 XSCN07
60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 XSCN06
50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 XSCN05
40
30
41
31
42
32
43
33
44
34
45
35
46
36
47
37
XSCN04 2
XSCN03
MICROCOMPUTER
20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 XSCN02
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 XSCN01
CONNECTION
00 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 XSCN00
(SERIAL)
3
-C -C -C -C -C 0V
MICROCOMPUTER
-C -C -C -C 24V
B20 XD00
CONNECTION
A20 XD01
(ETHERNET)
B19 XD02
A19 XD03
B18 XD04
A18 XD05
B17 XD06
A17
B16
XD07
XSCN0
4
A16 XSCN1
B15 XSCN2
MODBUS(R)/RTU
A15 XSCN3
CONNECTION
B14 XSCN4
A14 XSCN5
B13 XSCN6
A13 XSCN7
B12 YD00 A6TBY54-E
A12 YD01
B11 YD02 5
A11 YD03
B10 YD04
A10 YD05
MODBUS(R)/TCP
B9 YD06
CONNECTION
A9 YD07
B8 YD08
A8 YD09
B7 YD0A
A7 YD0B
B6
A6
YD0C
YD0D 6
B5 YD0E
A5 YD0F
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
B4 24V
A4 24V
B3 24V
A3 0V
B2 0V
UNIT
A2
B1
A1
10 -C 12 14 -C 16 18 -C 1A 1C -C 1E -C 0V
7
11 -C 13 15 -C 17 19 -C 1B 1D -C 1F 24V
CONNECTION TO
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
Load
EXTERNAL I/O
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
Controller setting 2. 3.
Set the channel of the equipment to be connected to
the GOT.
2.
3.
4.
Click!
Click!
Click the [OK] button when settings are completed. (1) Communication interface setting by the Utility
The communication interface setting can be
changed on the Utility's [Communication setting]
POINT after writing [Communication Settings] of project
data.
The settings of connecting equipment can be set and For details on the Utility, refer to the following
confirmed in [I/F Communication Setting]. For details, manual.
refer to the following. User's Manual of GOT used.
1.1.2 I/F communication setting (2) Precedence in communication settings
When settings are made by GT Designer3 or the
Utility, the latest setting is effective.
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
External I/O function setting on GT
MONITORING
Designer3
Before using the operation panel, make the operation
panel setting.
For details, refer to the following manual. 2
GT Designer3 Version1 Screen Design Manual
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(SERIAL)
3
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
4
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
5
MODBUS(R)/TCP
CONNECTION
6
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
2
MICROCOMPUTER
FINGERPRINT
CONNECTION
(SERIAL)
8.
AUTHENTICATION DEVICE 3
CONNECTION
MICROCOMPUTER
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
4
MODBUS(R)/RTU
CONNECTION
8.1 Connectable Model List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 2
8.2 System Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 2
5
8.3 GOT Side Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 3
MODBUS(R)/TCP
8.4 Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 - 4
CONNECTION
6
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
UNIT
7
CONNECTION TO
EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE
8
DEVICE CONNECTION
AUTHENTICATION
FINGERPRINT
8-1
8. FINGERPRINT AUTHENTICATION
DEVICE CONNECTION
Fingerprint authentication
*1 8.2.1
device
Fingerprint
GOT PLC
unit
Connection cable
Varies according to
the fingerprint unit's Varies according to the
specifications. connection type.
HINT
System configuration between the GOT and PLC
For the system configuration between the GOT and PLC, refer to each chapter.
Mitsubishi Electric Products
Non-Mitsubishi Electric Products 1, Non-Mitsubishi Electric Products 2
Microcomputer, MODBUS Products, Peripherals
PROCEDURES FOR
PREPARATORY
MONITORING
8.3.1 Setting communication
interface Fingerprint authentication device setting
Controller setting 2. 2
Set the channel of the equipment to be connected to
MICROCOMPUTER
the GOT.
CONNECTION
2.
(SERIAL)
Click!
3
3. 1.
MICROCOMPUTER
Select [Common] [Peripheral Setting]
[Fingerprint Authentication] from the menu.
CONNECTION
(ETHERNET)
4. 2. Set the interface to which the fingerprint
authentication device is connected.
MODBUS(R)/RTU
POINT
CONNECTION
(1) For communication interface setting
Click!
For the fingerprint authentication device
connection, use the channel No.8 of standard
interface. 5
The following external devices, which use Channel
1. Select [Common] [Controller Setting] from the No.8, cannot be connected at the same time.
MODBUS(R)/TCP
menu. • RFID controller that uses the external
CONNECTION
authentication
2. The Controller Setting window is displayed. Select the • Barcode reader and RFID controller that require
channel to be used from the list menu. the power supply
(2) Communication interface setting by the Utility
3. Set Manufacturer, Controller Type, I/F, and Driver The communication interface setting can be 6
according to the connected equipment to be used. changed on the Utility's [Communication setting]
after writing [Communication Settings] of project
CONNECTION TO
SOUND OUTPUT
4. The detailed setting is displayed after Manufacturer, data.
Controller Type, I/F, and Driver are set. For details on the Utility, refer to the following
Make the settings according to the usage manuals. UNIT
Controller setting
The fingerprint authentication device requires the
power supply from the GOT. Therefore, set Channel
No. 8 using the standard interface.
If the channel No. other than Channel No. 8 is set, the
GOT does not recognize the device as a controller.
CONNECTION
PC REMOTE
9.
CONNECTION 11
VNC(R) SERVER
CONNECTION
12
9.1 Connectable Model List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 - 2
CONNECTION
VIDEO/RGB
9.2 System Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 - 2
9.3 GOT Side Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 - 3
9.4 System Configuration Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 - 5 13
9.5 Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 - 7
CONNECTION
PRINTER
14
CONNECTION
MULTIMEDIA
15
RFID CONNECTION
9-1
9. BAR CODE READER CONNECTION
9.1 Connectable Model List
For connectable bar code readers and system equipment, refer to the following Technical News.
List of valid devices applicable for GOT1000 series (GOT-A-0010)
POINT
When using the RS-232 communication unit
Use the RS-232 communication unit of the GOT for connecting to a barcode reader.
However, when the RS-232 communication unit is used, the power cannot be supplied to a bar code reader from
the GOT.
HINT
System configuration between the GOT and PLC
For the system configuration between the GOT and PLC, refer to each chapter.
Mitsubishi Electric Products
Non-Mitsubishi Electric Products 1, Non-Mitsubishi Electric Products 2
Microcomputer, MODBUS Products, Peripherals
Controller setting 2. 4.
10
Set the channel of the equipment to be connected to
the GOT.
CONNECTION
PC REMOTE
2.
11
3.
VNC(R) SERVER
CONNECTION
4. Click!
3.
12
1. Select [Common] [Peripheral Setting] [Bar
Code] from the menu.
CONNECTION
2.
VIDEO/RGB
Set the interface to which the bar code reader is
Click! connected.
CONNECTION
2. 4. Clicking the detail setting button displays the
PRINTER
The Controller Setting window is displayed. Select the
Communication Detail Settings dialog box for each
channel to be used from the list menu.
communication driver.Make the settings according to
3. Set Manufacturer, Controller Type, I/F, and Driver the usage environment.
14
according to the connected equipment to be used. 9.3.2 Communication detail settings
CONNECTION
Click the [OK] button when settings are completed. MULTIMEDIA
Controller Type, I/F, and Driver are set.
Make the settings according to the usage
environment. POINT
CONNECTION
Data Bit 8bit
PC REMOTE
D2 4 3
(34H) (33H)
Barcode D3 6 5 Stored data
Stop Bit 1bit
(36H) ( 35H)
D4 8 7 Parity Even
(38H) (37H)
D5 SP 9 Header None
11
(20H) (39H)
123456789
<GOT> *1
Terminator CR
VNC(R) SERVER
POINT
CONNECTION
<QCPU (Q mode)> Bar code reader setting
For the bar code reader setting, refer to the following
Read data Terminator manual.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 CR
User's Manual of the bar code reader 12
31H 32H 33H 34H 35H 36H 37H 38H 39H 0DH
CONNECTION
For bus connection, refer to the following manual.
Designer3
VIDEO/RGB
GOT1000 Series Connection Manual (Mitsubishi
Electric Products) for GT Works3 (1) Controller setting
1. The bar code is read with the bar code reader.
■ Bar code reader setting 13
2. The GOT receives the data sent from the bar code
CONNECTION
reader.
■ Setting of [Controller Setting] of GT
PRINTER
Designer3
CONNECTION
into the PLC CPU devices. MULTIMEDIA
■ Confirmation on PLC side
(2) Communication detail settings
Keep consistency with the bar code reader setting.
POINT
[Controller Setting] of GT Designer3
For the setting method of [Controller Setting] of GT
Designer3, refer to the following.
9.3.1Setting communication interface
Startup procedure
GX Developer [Online] [Monitor] [Device
batch]
Header*1 None
Terminator*1 CR
POINT
[Bar Code] of GT Designer3
For the [Bar Code] setting in GT Designer3, refer to the
following manual.
GT Designer3 Version1 Screen Design Manual
CONNECTION
When using the barcode reader, which requires the
PC REMOTE
power supply from the GOT, set Channel No. 8 using
the standard interface.
With Channels No. 5 to 7 of the extension interface, the
power cannot be supplied. 11
VNC(R) SERVER
CONNECTION
12
CONNECTION
VIDEO/RGB
13
CONNECTION
PRINTER
14
CONNECTION
MULTIMEDIA
15
RFID CONNECTION
PC REMOTE CONNECTION
CONNECTION
PC REMOTE
10.
11
10.1 Connectable Model List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 2
VNC(R) SERVER
10.2 Serial Connection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 2
CONNECTION
12
10.3 Ethernet Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 - 7
CONNECTION
VIDEO/RGB
13
CONNECTION
PRINTER
14
CONNECTION
MULTIMEDIA
15
RFID CONNECTION
10 - 1
10. PC REMOTE CONNECTION
10.1 Connectable Model List
The RGB display is used for the remote personal computer operation connection.
The following GOT models support the remote personal computer operation connection.
PC GOT PLC
Connection cable 1)
Connection cable 2)
HINT
System configuration between the GOT and PLC
For the system configuration between the GOT and PLC, refer to each chapter.
Mitsubishi Electric Products
Non-Mitsubishi Electric Products 1, Non-Mitsubishi Electric Products 2
Microcomputer, MODBUS Products, Peripherals
CONNECTION
GOT to a personal computer, the cable must be prepared Analog RGB connection diagram 1)
by the user.
The following shows each cable connection diagram. 75Ω drohmcoaxial
PC side GOT side
10
RS-232 cable R 1 1 R
CONNECTION
RS232 connection diagram 1)
PC REMOTE
G 2 2 G
B 3 3 B
CD 1 1 CD
RD 2 3 SD
BGND 8 8 BGND
11
DGND 10 10 GND
SD 3 2 RD
VNC(R) SERVER
HSYNC 13 13 HSYNC
CONNECTION
DTR 4 6 DSR
VSYNC 14 14 VSYNC
SG(GND) 5 5 SG(GND)
DGND 5 5 GND
DSR 6 4 DTR
NC 4 4 GND
RTS 7 7 RTS
12
Twisted pair
NC 9 9 NC
CTS 8 8 CTS
NC 11 11 GND
9 9 CI
NC 12 12 SDA
CONNECTION
FG Shell Shell FG
VIDEO/RGB
NC 15 15 SCL
CONNECTION
1.4.1 GOT connector specifications personal computer.
PRINTER
(c) Personal computer side connector (b) GOT side connector
Use a connector compatible with the personal Use the following as the video/RGB input unit and
computer to be used. the RGB input unit connectors.
For the GOT side connector and connector cover 14
of the analog RGB cable, use the ones applicable
to the GOT connector.
CONNECTION
Connector
GOT Connector type Manufacturer MULTIMEDIA
type
GT16M-R2
GT15V-75V4R1
2.
3.
4.
Click!
POINT
The settings of connecting equipment can be set and
confirmed in [I/F Communication Setting]. For details,
refer to the following.
1.1.2 I/F communication setting
CONNECTION
Make the settings according to the usage environment.
2. 4.
10
CONNECTION
PC REMOTE
11
Item Description Range
Video Input Set the video input signal.
VNC(R) SERVER
NTSC, PAL
Signal*1 (Default: NTSC)
CONNECTION
640 480,
Video Set the video resolution.
Click! *2 720 480,
Resolution (Default: 640 480)
3. 768 576*3
CONNECTION
VIDEO/RGB
2. Set the interface to which the video/RGB equipment is POINT
connected.
(1) Communication interface setting
3. Check the [Use Video/RGB Input] to set the function.
For details on the function setting, refer to the
When Channel No.8 is used, the following external
devices, which use Channel No.8, cannot be
13
following manual. connected at the same time.
• Fingerprint authentication device
GT Designer3 Version1 Screen Design Manual • RFID controller that uses the external
CONNECTION
authentication
4. Clicking the detail setting button displays the
PRINTER
• Barcode reader and RFID controller that require
Communication Detail Settings dialog box for each the power supply
communication driver.Make the settings according to When connecting the above-mentioned devices at
the usage environment. the same time, set [PC Remote Operation] to
Channels No. 5 to 7. 14
10.2.4 Communication detail settings (2) Communication interface setting by the Utility
The communication interface setting can be
CONNECTION
Click the [OK] button when settings are completed. changed on the Utility's [Communication setting]
MULTIMEDIA
after writing [Communication Settings] of project
data.
POINT For details on the Utility, refer to the following
manual.
Setting for the driver User's Manual of GOT used. 15
To Channels No. 5 to 8, multiple [PC Remote (3) Precedence in communication settings
RFID CONNECTION
10.2.6 Precautions
CONNECTION
PC REMOTE
PC GOT PLC
Connection cable
11
Varies according to the
connection type.
VNC(R) SERVER
CONNECTION
Maximum GOT Number of
Personal computer Connection cable*2 segment PLC connectable
Option device Model
length*4 equipment
CONNECTION
• 100BASE-TX refer to each chapter.
VIDEO/RGB
Shielded twisted pair cable (STP):
Category 5 and 5e
*1 The destination connected with the twisted pair cable varies with the configuration of the applicable Ethernet network system.
Connect to the Ethernet module, hub, transceiver, wireless LAN adapter (NZ2WL-JPA or NZ2WL-JPS), or other system
equipment corresponding to the applicable Ethernet network system. 13
Use cables, connectors, and hubs that meet the IEEE802.3 10BASE-T/100BASE-TX standard.
For the controllers that can be connected to the wireless LAN adapters and how to set the wireless LAN adapter, refer to the
manual of the wireless LAN adapter used.
CONNECTION
*2 A straight cable is available.
When connecting the GOT and PC directly with Ethernet cable, remember that the by cross cable is available.
PRINTER
*3 When connecting GT16 of the function version A to an equipment that meets the 10BASE (-T/2/5) standard, use the switching
hub and operate in a 10Mbps/100Mbps mixed environment.
For how to check the function version, refer to the following.
GT16 User’s Manual (Hardware) 14
*4 A length between a hub and a node.
The maximum distance differs depending on the Ethernet device to be used.
The following shows the number of the connectable nodes when a repeater hub is used.
CONNECTION
• 10BASE-T: Max. 4 nodes for a cascade connection (500m)
MULTIMEDIA
• 100BASE-TX: Max. 2 nodes for a cascade connection (205m)
When switching hubs are used, the cascade connection between the switching hubs has no logical limit for the number of
cascades.
For the limit, contact the switching hub manufacturer.
15
HINT
RFID CONNECTION
2.
3.
4.
Click!
3.
1. Select [Common] [Controller Setting] from the 3. Check the [Use PC Remote Operation (Ethernet)] of
menu. [PC Remote Operation (Ethernet)] to set. For details
on the settings, refer to the following manual.
2. The Controller Setting window is displayed. Select the
GT Designer3 Version1 Screen Design Manual
channel to be used from the list menu.
Click the [OK] button when settings are completed.
3. Set Manufacturer, Controller Type, I/F, and Driver
according to the connected equipment to be used. 10.3.3 Install and setting the required
4. The detailed setting is displayed after Manufacturer, software
Controller Type, I/F, and Driver are set.
Make the settings according to the usage Install and set the required software according to the
environment. system configuration.
Click the [OK] button when settings are completed. For the settings, refer to the following manual.
GT Designer3 Version1 Screen Design Manual
POINT
10.3.4 Precautions
The settings of connecting equipment can be set and
confirmed in [I/F Communication Setting]. For details,
refer to the following.
Ethernet system driver
Before using the PC remote operation function
1.1.2 I/F communication setting
(Ethernet), install an Ethernet system communication
driver to the GOT.
Set the Ethernet system communication driver for the
controller setting or peripheral setting.
For the settings, refer to the following manual.
GT Designer3 Version1 Screen Design Manual
CONNECTION
PC REMOTE
11.
11
VNC(R) SERVER
CONNECTION
11.1 Connectable Model List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11 - 2
12
11.2 System Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11 - 2
11.3 GOT Side Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11 - 3
CONNECTION
VIDEO/RGB
11.4 Setting in Personal Computer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .11 - 4
13
CONNECTION
PRINTER
14
CONNECTION
MULTIMEDIA
15
RFID CONNECTION
11 - 1
11. VNC(R) SERVER CONNECTION
PC Ultra VNC
PC GOT
(VNC R server) PLC
(VNC R client)
Connection cable
Maximum ® Number of
Personal computer GOT (VNC server)
Connection cable*1*2 segment PLC connectable
®
(VNC client)
length*4 Option device Model equipment
Twisted pair cable
• 10BASE-T
Shielded twisted pair cable (STP) For the system
*3 1 personal
To be selected by the or unshielded twisted pair cable configuration between
100m - (Built into GOT) computer for 1
user. (UTP): Category 3, 4, and 5 *5 the GOT and PLC,
GOT
• 100BASE-TX refer to each chapter.
Shielded twisted pair cable (STP):
Category 5 and 5e
*1 The destination connected with the twisted pair cable varies with the configuration of the applicable Ethernet network system.
Connect to the Ethernet module, hub, transceiver, wireless LAN adapter (NZ2WL-JPA or NZ2WL-JPS), or other system
equipment corresponding to the applicable Ethernet network system.
Use cables, connectors, and hubs that meet the IEEE802.3 10BASE-T/100BASE-TX standard.
For the controllers that can be connected to the wireless LAN adapters and how to set the wireless LAN adapter, refer to the
manual of the wireless LAN adapter used.
*2 A straight cable is available.
When connecting the GOT and PC directly with Ethernet cable, remember that the by cross cable is available.
*3 When connecting GT16 of the function version A to an equipment that meets the 10BASE (-T/2/5) standard, use the switching
hub and operate in a 10Mbps/100Mbps mixed environment.
For how to check the function version, refer to the following.
GT16 User’s Manual (Hardware)
*4 A length between a hub and a node.
The maximum distance differs depending on the Ethernet device to be used.
The following shows the number of the connectable nodes when a repeater hub is used.
• 10BASE-T: Max. 4 nodes for a cascade connection (500m)
• 100BASE-TX: Max. 2 nodes for a cascade connection (205m)
When switching hubs are used, the cascade connection between the switching hubs has no logical limit for the number of
cascades.
For the limit, contact the switching hub manufacturer.
*5 GT14 models compatible with Ethernet connection are only GT1455-QTBDE, GT1450-QMBDE and GT1450-QLBDE.
CONNECTION
System configuration between the GOT and PLC
For the system configuration between the GOT and PLC, refer to each chapter.
Mitsubishi Electric Products
Non-Mitsubishi Electric Products 1, Non-Mitsubishi Electric Products 2 10
Microcomputer, MODBUS Products, Peripherals
CONNECTION
PC REMOTE
11.3 GOT Side Settings
11
11.3.1 VNC(R) server function setting 11.3.2 Setting communication
VNC(R) SERVER
interface (Communication
CONNECTION
settings)
2.
For using the VNC® server, Ethernet
communication drivers must be set on the GOT, 12
and set the Communication settings
2.
CONNECTION
VIDEO/RGB
3. 13
4.
CONNECTION
PRINTER
14
Click!
Click!
CONNECTION
MULTIMEDIA
1. Select [Common] [Peripheral Setting] [VNC
Server] from the menu. 1. Select [Common] [Controller Setting] from the
menu.
2. Check the [VNC Server] of [Use VNC Server] to set. 15
For details on the settings, refer to the following 2. The Controller Setting window is displayed. Select the
RFID CONNECTION
VIDEO/RGB CONNECTION
CONNECTION
PC REMOTE
12.
11
VNC(R) SERVER
CONNECTION
12.1 Connectable Model List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 - 2
12
12.2 System Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 - 2
12.3 Connection Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 - 4
CONNECTION
VIDEO/RGB
12.4 GOT Side Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 - 6
12.5 Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 - 7
13
CONNECTION
PRINTER
14
CONNECTION
MULTIMEDIA
15
RFID CONNECTION
12 - 1
12. VIDEO/RGB CONNECTION
GOT model
For the type of the video camera that can be connected, refer to the following Technical News.
List of valid devices applicable for GOT1000 series (GOT-A-0010)
Extended function OS
Video/RGB input
CONNECTION
(1) Power supply of video camera
Depending on the video camera type, noises from the power supply cable of the camera may cause a
malfunction on the PLC or the GOT.In this case, apply the following line filter to the power line of the camera.
Recommended line filter: TDK ZHC2203-11 (or equivalent)
(2) Power supply of vision sensor 10
If a video camera is used via a vision sensor, a power supply module may be required depending on the vision
sensor to be used.
CONNECTION
(3) Selection of Video signal output source
PC REMOTE
Depending on the video camera or the system to be used, both the power supply module and the video
camera can output video signals. If video signals are output from both the video camera and the power supply
module, the voltage level of the signals become lower and the video image cannot be correctly displayed. In
this case, use the output from the video camera. 11
(4) Power-On of video camera
Turn on the video camera simultaneously with the GOT.
VNC(R) SERVER
CONNECTION
12.2.2 Displaying GOT screen on external monitor
12
CONNECTION
External monitor GOT
VIDEO/RGB
Connection cable
13
External monitor Connection cable GOT Number of
Signal
CONNECTION
Distance connectable
type Model name Model name Option device Model
equipment
PRINTER
For connectable external monitor types, refer to the GT15-C50VG(5m) GT16M-ROUT
Analog following Technical News. or
*1 1 for 1 GOT
RGB List of valid devices applicable for GOT1000 Analog RGB connection
series (GOT-A-0010) diagram 2)
GT15V-75ROUT
14
*1 The cable length differs depending on the specification of the external monitor used by the user.
CONNECTION
MULTIMEDIA
15
RFID CONNECTION
Video camera/
GOT side 75Ω drohmcoaxial
vision sensor side 12.3.2 Analog RGB cable
Signal Signal
BNC connector
GND GND
BNC connector
Connection diagram
Analog RGB connection diagram 1)
Displaying video image on GOT
Cable specification
Vision sensor/PC side 75Ω drohmcoaxial GOT side
Item Specifications
R 1 1 R
Applicable cable 3C-2V, 5C-2V (JIS C 3501 compliant) RGND 6 6 RGND
G 2 2 G
GGND 7 7 GGND
Connecting the BNC connector to the coaxial B 3 3 B
BGND BGND
cable GND
8
10
8
10 GND
For how to connect the BNC connector and coaxial HSYNC 13 13 HSYNC
cable, refer to the following. VSYNC 14 14 VSYNC
GND 5 5 GND
1.4.2 Coaxial cable connector connection GND 4 4 NC
method NC 9 9 NC
Twisted pair
GND 11 11 NC
Precautions when preparing a cable SDA 12 12 NC
SC 15 15 NC
(1) Cable length
The cable length differs depending on the specification Analog RGB connection diagram 2)
of the video camera or vision sensor to be used. Displaying GOT screen on external monitor
Create a cable under the specifications of the video External monitor
camera/vision sensor. GOT side 75Ω drohmcoaxial side
CONNECTION
The cable length differs depending on the specification
of the vision sensor/PC to be used. Create a cable
under the specifications of the vision sensor/PC.
CONNECTION
analog RGB cable, use the ones applicable to the GOT
PC REMOTE
connector.
Connector
GOT Connector model Manufacturer
type
GT16M-R2 11
GT16M-V4R1
VNC(R) SERVER
GT16M-ROUT
CONNECTION
D-Sub 15-pin DDK Ltd.
17HE-R13150-73MC2
(female) (DDK)
GT15V-75R1
GT15V-75V4R1
GT15V-75ROUT
12
(3) Vision sensor/PC side connector
Use a connector compatible with the vision sensor/
CONNECTION
personal computer to be used.
VIDEO/RGB
13
CONNECTION
PRINTER
14
CONNECTION
MULTIMEDIA
15
RFID CONNECTION
Controller setting 2. 4.
Set the channel of the equipment to be connected to
the GOT.
2.
3.
4.
Click!
3.
POINT
The settings of connecting equipment can be set and
confirmed in [I/F Communication Setting]. For details,
refer to the following.
1.1.2 I/F communication setting
CONNECTION
For the video/RGB function setting, refer to the following
manual.
GT Designer3 Version1 Screen Design Manual
10
CONNECTION
PC REMOTE
11
VNC(R) SERVER
CONNECTION
Item Description Range
CONNECTION
768
VIDEO/RGB
*1 When NTSC format is selected, the resolution is fixed to
640 480.
*2 For GT1675M-V and GT1665M-V, the resolution is fixed to
640 480.
*3 768 576 can be set only for the GT16.
13
POINT
CONNECTION
PRINTER
(1) Communication interface setting by the Utility
The communication interface setting can be
changed on the Utility's [Communication setting]
after writing [Communication Settings] of project 14
data.
For details on the Utility, refer to the following
manual.
CONNECTION
User's Manual of GOT used. MULTIMEDIA
12.5 Precautions
Connecting to PC
When connecting to a PC, ground the earth wire of the
PC.
PRINTER CONNECTION
CONNECTION
PC REMOTE
13.
11
VNC(R) SERVER
CONNECTION
13.1 Connectable Model List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 - 2
12
13.2 System Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 - 2
13.3 GOT Side Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 - 4
CONNECTION
VIDEO/RGB
13.4 Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 - 6
13
CONNECTION
PRINTER
14
CONNECTION
MULTIMEDIA
15
RFID CONNECTION
13 - 1
13. PRINTER CONNECTION
13.1 Connectable Model List
For connectable printers and system equipment, refer to the following Technical News.
List of valid devices applicable for GOT1000 series (GOT-A-0010)
PictBridge
compatible GOT PLC
printer
Connection cable
*1 Communication unit between the GOT and the PictBridge compatible printer.
GOT does not support some PictBridge Compatible Printers. For the precautions for printer connection, refer to the following
Technical News.
List of valid devices applicable for GOT1000 series (GOT-A-0010)
HINT
System configuration between the GOT and PLC
For the system configuration between the GOT and PLC, refer to each chapter.
Mitsubishi Electric Products
Non-Mitsubishi Electric Products 1, Non-Mitsubishi Electric Products 2
Microcomputer, MODBUS Products, Peripherals
CONNECTION
Printer (serial) Connection type
dependent
Serial
GOT PLC
10
printer
CONNECTION
PC REMOTE
Varies according to the connection type.
VNC(R) SERVER
equipment
CONNECTION
For connectable printers and - (Built into
- For the system
system equipment, refer to the GOT)
following Technical News. configuration
1 printer for
RS-232 cable GT10-C02H-6PT9P - (Built into between the GOT
List of valid devices 1 GOT
(0.2m) GOT) and PLC, refer to
applicable for GOT1000
series (GOT-A-0010) - GT15-RS2-9P
each chapter. 12
*1 The RS-232 cable differs depending on the specification of the printer to be used. Use the RS-232 cable that is compatible with
the printer to be used.
CONNECTION
VIDEO/RGB
HINT
System configuration between the GOT and PLC 13
For the system configuration between the GOT and PLC, refer to each chapter.
Mitsubishi Electric Products
CONNECTION
Non-Mitsubishi Electric Products 1, Non-Mitsubishi Electric Products 2
PRINTER
Microcomputer, MODBUS Products, Peripherals
14
CONNECTION
MULTIMEDIA
15
RFID CONNECTION
Controller setting 2. 4.
(For GT16, GT15)
Set the channel of the equipment to be connected to
the GOT.
2.
Click!
3. 3.
CONNECTION
(1) Communication interface setting by the Utility
The communication interface setting can be
changed on the Utility's [Communication setting]
after writing [Communication Settings] of project
data.
For details on the Utility, refer to the following
10
manual.
User's Manual of GOT used.
CONNECTION
PC REMOTE
(2) Precedence in communication settings
When settings are made by GT Designer3 or the
Utility, the latest setting is effective.
11
VNC(R) SERVER
CONNECTION
Item Description Range
4800bps,
Set this item when change the 9600bps, 12
Transmission transmission speed used for 19200bps,
Speed communication with printer. 38400bps,
(Default: 19200bps) 57600bps,
CONNECTION
115200bps
VIDEO/RGB
Set this item when change the
data length used for
Data Bit*1 7bits/8bits
communication with printer.
(Default: 8bits)
13
Specify the stop bit length for
Stop Bit communications. 1bit/2bits
(Default: 1bit)
CONNECTION
Specify whether or not to
PRINTER
perform a parity check, and how None
Parity it is performed during Even
communication. Odd
(Default: None)
CONNECTION
(Default: 0times)
MULTIMEDIA
Set the time period for a
Timeout Time communication to time out. 3 to 90sec
(Default: 30sec)
MULTIMEDIA CONNECTION
CONNECTION
PC REMOTE
14.
11
VNC(R) SERVER
CONNECTION
14.1 Connectable Model List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 - 2
12
14.2 System Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 - 2
14.3 Connection Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 - 4
CONNECTION
VIDEO/RGB
14.4 GOT Side Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 - 5
14.5 Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 - 7
13
CONNECTION
PRINTER
14
CONNECTION
MULTIMEDIA
15
RFID CONNECTION
14 - 1
14. MULTIMEDIA CONNECTION
POINT
Before making the multimedia connection
Update the software version of the multimedia unit to the latest version.
For the version upgrade of the multimedia unit, refer to the following manual.
GT16 User’s Manual (Hardware)
Extended function OS
Multimedia
Video camera,
Microphone, GOT
Speaker
Connection cable
*1 The cable length differs depending on the specification of the video camera used by the user.
*2 For the CF card to be inserted into the multimedia unit, refer to the following.
• Type of CF card that can be inserted
List of valid devices applicable for GOT1000 series (GOT-A-0010)
• Precautions for using the CF card
14.4 GOT Side Settings
*3 For the type of the video camera that can be connected, refer to the following Technical News.
CONNECTION
Multimedia Gateway (FTP) Connection type
dependent
Video camera,
Microphone, GOT PC 10
Speaker
Connection cable 1) Connection cable 2)
CONNECTION
interface 1) interface 2)
PC REMOTE
Connection cable 1) GOT*2*3 Connection cable 2)
Number of
Multimedia
controller
Signal
type Model name
Max. Option device
Model
Option device
Cable model
Maximum
segment
Personal
computer connectable 11
distance (Interface 1)) (Interface 2)) *6 equipment
length*8
VNC(R) SERVER
Ethernet Twisted pair cable
CONNECTION
Interface • 10BASE-T
(Built into GOT) Shielded twisted
pair cable (STP) or To be
Coaxial unshielded twisted 1 multimedia
NTSC *4
selected
*5 connection *1 GT16M-MMR pair cable (UTP): 100m controller for 1
/PAL by the
12
*7 Category 3, 4, and 5
diagram 1) GOT
GT16M-MMR • 100BASE-TX user.
Shielded twisted pair
cable (STP):
Category 5 and 5e
CONNECTION
*1 The cable length differs depending on the specification of the video camera used by the user.
VIDEO/RGB
*2 The destination connected with the twisted pair cable varies with the configuration of the applicable Ethernet network system.
Connect to the Ethernet module, hub, transceiver, wireless LAN adapter (NZ2WL-JPA or NZ2WL-JPS), or other system
equipment corresponding to the applicable Ethernet network system.
Use cables, connectors, and hubs that meet the IEEE802.3 10BASE-T/100BASE-TX standards.
For the controllers that can be connected to the wireless LAN adapters and how to set the wireless LAN adapter, refer to the
manual of the wireless LAN adapter used.
13
*3 When connecting GT16 of the function version A to an equipment that meets the 10BASE (-T/2/5) standard, use the switching
hub and operate in a 10Mbps/100Mbps mixed environment.
CONNECTION
For how to check the function version, refer to the following.
GT16 User’s Manual (Hardware)
PRINTER
*4 For the CF card to be inserted into the multimedia unit, refer to the following.
• Type of CF card that can be inserted
List of valid devices applicable for GOT1000 series (GOT-A-0010)
• Precautions for using the CF card 14
14.4 GOT Side Settings
*5 For the type of the video camera that can be connected, refer to the following Technical News.
CONNECTION
List of valid devices applicable for GOT1000 series (GOT-A-0010) MULTIMEDIA
*6 Install the multimedia interaction tool before use.
For details of the multimedia interaction tool, refer to the following manual.
GT Designer3 Version1 Screen Design Manual
*7 GT1675-VN, GT1672-VN, and GT1662-VN cannot be used.
*8 A length between a hub and a node. 15
The maximum distance differs depending on the Ethernet device to be used.
RFID CONNECTION
The following shows the number of the connectable nodes when a repeater hub is used.
• 10BASE-T: Max. 4 nodes for a cascade connection (500m)
• 100BASE-TX: Max. 2 nodes for a cascade connection (205m)
When switching hubs are used, the cascade connection between the switching hubs has no logical limit for the number of
cascades.
For the limit, contact the switching hub manufacturer.
POINT
Power supply of video camera
Depending on the video camera type, noises from the power supply cable of the camera may cause a malfunction
on the PLC or the GOT. In this case, apply the following line filter to the power line of the camera.
Recommended line filter: TDK ZHC2203-11 (or equivalent)
Cable specification
Item Specifications
Controller setting 2. 4.
10
Set the channel of the equipment to be connected to
the GOT.
CONNECTION
PC REMOTE
2.
11
3.
VNC(R) SERVER
CONNECTION
4.
12
CONNECTION
VIDEO/RGB
Click!
Click!
3. 13
1. Select [Common] [Controller Setting] from the
menu.
1.
CONNECTION
Select [Common] [Peripheral Setting]
2.
PRINTER
The Controller Setting window is displayed. Select the [Multimedia] from the menu.
channel to be used from the list menu.
2. Set the interface to which the multimedia controller is
3. Set Manufacturer, Controller Type, I/F, and Driver connected.
14
according to the connected equipment to be used.
3. Check the [Enable the setting of Multimedia] to set the
4. The detailed setting is displayed after Manufacturer, function. For details on the communication settings,
CONNECTION
Controller Type, I/F, and Driver are set. refer to the following manual. MULTIMEDIA
Make the settings according to the usage GT Designer3 Version1 Screen Design Manual
environment.
4. Clicking the detail setting button displays the
POINT
When saving a video image and displaying it on the
GOT, the installation and setting of the multimedia
interaction tool onto the personal computer are
unnecessary.
POINT
Network settings with the utility
The network setting can be changed on the Utility's
[Communication setting] after writing [Communication
Settings] of project data.
For details on the Utility, refer to the following manual.
User's Manual of GOT used.
CONNECTION
multimedia unit, formatting in FAT32 is recommended.
PC REMOTE
If the CF card formatted in FAT16 is inserted, the
following phenomena may occur.
• Reading, writing or saving of movie files takes time.
• When a movie file is played, the movie momentarily 11
looks like as if it stopped.
VNC(R) SERVER
CONNECTION
12
CONNECTION
VIDEO/RGB
13
CONNECTION
PRINTER
14
CONNECTION
MULTIMEDIA
15
RFID CONNECTION
RFID CONNECTION
CONNECTION
PC REMOTE
15.
11
VNC(R) SERVER
CONNECTION
15.1 Connectable Model List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 - 2
12
15.2 System Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 - 2
15.3 GOT Side Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 - 3
CONNECTION
VIDEO/RGB
15.4 Precautions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 - 5
13
CONNECTION
PRINTER
14
CONNECTION
MULTIMEDIA
15
RFID CONNECTION
15 - 1
15. RFID CONNECTION
15.1 Connectable Model List
For connectable RFID controllers and system equipment, refer to the following Technical bulletin.
List of valid devices applicable for GOT1000 series (GOT-A-0010)
Visit the Mitsubishi Electric FA Equipment Information Service website (MELFANSweb) to refer to the Technical News.
http://wwwf2.mitsubishielectric.co.jp/english/index.html
RFID controller
GOT PLC
Connection cable
POINT
When using the RS-232 communication unit
Use the RS-232 communication unit of the GOT for connecting to an RFID controller.
However, when the RS-232 communication unit is used, the following operations cannot be supported.
(a) Using the external authentication
(b) Supplying the power to an RFID controller from the GOT
HINT
System configuration between the GOT and PLC
For the system configuration between the GOT and PLC, refer to each chapter.
Mitsubishi Electric Products
Non-Mitsubishi Electric Products 1, Non-Mitsubishi Electric Products 2
Microcomputer, MODBUS Products, Peripherals
CONNECTION
PC REMOTE
3. 11
VNC(R) SERVER
4.
CONNECTION
12
Click!
CONNECTION
Click!
VIDEO/RGB
1. Select [Common] [Peripheral Setting] [RFID]
from the menu.
1. Select [Common] [Controller Setting] from the 2. Set the interface to which the RFID controller is 13
menu. connected.
2. The Controller Setting window is displayed. Select the 3. Select the [RFID Controller] to set the function. For
CONNECTION
channel to be used from the list menu. details on the function setting, refer to the following
PRINTER
manual.
3. Set Manufacturer, Controller Type, I/F, and Driver GT Designer3 Version1 Screen Design Manual
according to the connected equipment to be used.
4. Clicking the detail setting button displays the 14
4. The detailed setting is displayed after Manufacturer, Communication Detail Settings dialog box for each
Controller Type, I/F, and Driver are set. communication driver.Make the settings according to
Make the settings according to the usage
CONNECTION
the usage environment.
MULTIMEDIA
environment.
15.3.2 Communication detail settings
Click the [OK] button when settings are completed. Click the [OK] button when settings are completed.
15
POINT POINT
RFID CONNECTION
The settings of connecting equipment can be set and (1) Communication interface setting
confirmed in [I/F Communication Setting]. For details, When Channel No.8 is used, the following external
refer to the following. devices, which use Channel No.8, cannot be
1.1.2 I/F communication setting connected at the same time.
• Fingerprint authentication device
• Barcode reader that requires the power supply
When connecting the above-mentioned devices at
the same time, set [RFID] to Channels No. 5 to 7.
(2) Setting for the driver
To Channels No. 5 to 8, multiple [RFID] cannot be
set.
CONNECTION
PC REMOTE
(1) When using the external authentication
When using the external authentication on the RFID
controller, set Channel No. 8 using the standard
interface.
When connecting the RFID using Channels No. 5 to 7 11
of the extension interface, extension interface cannot
be used.
VNC(R) SERVER
For details on the external authentication, refer to the
CONNECTION
following manual.
GT Designer3 Version1 Screen Design Manual
(2) When requiring the power supply
When using the RFID controller, which requires the
power supply from the GOT, set Channel No. 8 using
12
the standard interface.
With Channels No. 5 to 7 of the extension interface, the
CONNECTION
power cannot be supplied.
VIDEO/RGB
Communication in multiple RFID readers/
writers connection
When connecting multiple RFID readers/writers, some
controllers may communicate with each RFID reader/
13
writer.
For communicating the RFID controller with the each
CONNECTION
RFID reader/writer, set an interlock so that the RFID
PRINTER
controller does not communicate with RFID readers/
writers until the executing communication is completed.
14
CONNECTION
MULTIMEDIA
15
RFID CONNECTION
INDEX
MODBUS(R)/RTU CONNECTION................... 4-12
[C] MODBUS(R)/TCP CONNECTION ..................... 5-3
MULTIMEDIA CONNECTION.......................... 14-5
Coaxial cable ....................................................... 1-27 PC REMOTE CONNECTION................... 10-4,10-8
Communication module....................................... 1-15
PRINTER CONNECTION ................................ 13-4
Connectable Model List
RFID CONNECTION........................................ 15-3
BAR CODE READER CONNECTION ............... 9-2
VIDEO/RGB CONNECTION ............................ 12-6
CONNECTION TO EXTERNAL I/O DEVICE..... 7-2
VNC(R) SERVER CONNECTION.................... 11-3
CONNECTION TO SOUND OUTPUT UNIT...... 6-2
FINGERPRINT AUTHENTICATION DEVICE
CONNECTION................................................... 8-2 [I]
MODBUS(R)/RTU CONNECTION..................... 4-2 I/F........................................................................... 1-6
MODBUS(R)/TCP CONNECTION..................... 5-2 I/F communication setting.................................... 1-10
MULTIMEDIA CONNECTION.......................... 14-2
PC REMOTE CONNECTION .......................... 10-2 [M]
PRINTER CONNECTION ................................ 13-2 MICROCOMPUTER CONNECTION
RFID CONNECTION ....................................... 15-2 (ETHERNET) ......................................................... 3-1
VIDEO/RGB CONNECTION............................ 12-2 MICROCOMPUTER CONNECTION (SERIAL)..... 2-1
VNC(R) SERVER CONNECTION ................... 11-2 MODBUS(R)/RTU CONNECTION ........................ 4-1
Connection Diagram MODBUS(R)/TCP CONNECTION......................... 5-1
CONNECTION TO EXTERNAL I/O DEVICE..... 7-4 MULTIMEDIA CONNECTION ............................. 14-1
MICROCOMPUTER CONNECTION
(SERIAL)............................................................ 2-6 [O]
MODBUS(R)/RTU CONNECTION..................... 4-4 Option unit ........................................................... 1-16
MULTIMEDIA CONNECTION.......................... 14-4
PC REMOTE CONNECTION .......................... 10-3
[P]
VIDEO/RGB CONNECTION............................ 12-4
CONNECTION TO EXTERNAL I/O DEVICE ........ 7-1 PC REMOTE CONNECTION .............................. 10-1
CONNECTION TO SOUND OUTPUT UNIT ......... 6-1 Precautions
Controller Type ...................................................... 1-5 BAR CODE READER CONNECTION ............... 9-7
Conversion cable................................................. 1-16 CONNECTION TO EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE............................................................ 7-13
[D] CONNECTION TO SOUND OUTPUT UNIT...... 6-4
FINGERPRINT AUTHENTICATION DEVICE
Device Range that Can Be Set
CONNECTION ................................................... 8-4
MICROCOMPUTER CONNECTION
MICROCOMPUTER CONNECTION
(SERIAL).......................................................... 2-82
(ETHERNET) ................................................... 3-74
MODBUS(R)/TCP CONNECTION..................... 5-6
MICROCOMPUTER CONNECTION
(SERIAL) .......................................................... 2-83
[F] MODBUS(R)/RTU CONNECTION................... 4-18
FINGERPRINT AUTHENTICATION DEVICE MODBUS(R)/TCP CONNECTION ................... 5-15
CONNECTION ...................................................... 8-1 MULTIMEDIA CONNECTION.......................... 14-7
PRINTER CONNECTION ................................ 13-6
[G] VIDEO/RGB CONNECTION ............................ 12-7
GOT connector specifications ............................. 1-24 PREPARATORY PROCEDURES FOR
GOT Side Settings MONITORING ....................................................... 1-1
BAR CODE READER CONNECTION ............... 9-3 PRINTER CONNECTION.................................... 13-1
CONNECTION TO EXTERNAL I/O DEVICE... 7-12
CONNECTION TO SOUND OUTPUT UNIT...... 6-3 [R]
FINGERPRINT AUTHENTICATION DEVICE RFID CONNECTION ........................................... 15-1
CONNECTION................................................... 8-3
MICROCOMPUTER CONNECTION [S]
(ETHERNET) ................................................... 3-69
Station No. settings
MODBUS(R)/RTU CONNECTION................... 4-17
Index-1
System Configuration
BAR CODE READER CONNECTION ............... 9-2
CONNECTION TO EXTERNAL I/O
DEVICE........................................................ 7-2,7-3
CONNECTION TO SOUND OUTPUT UNIT...... 6-2
FINGERPRINT AUTHENTICATION DEVICE
CONNECTION ................................................... 8-2
MICROCOMPUTER CONNECTION
(ETHERNET) ..................................................... 3-2
MICROCOMPUTER CONNECTION
(SERIAL) ............................................................ 2-4
MODBUS(R)/RTU CONNECTION..................... 4-3
MULTIMEDIA CONNECTION.................. 14-2,14-3
PC REMOTE CONNECTION................... 10-2,10-7
PRINTER CONNECTION ................................ 13-2
RFID CONNECTION........................................ 15-2
VIDEO/RGB CONNECTION .................... 12-2,12-3
VNC(R) SERVER CONNECTION.................... 11-2
[T]
Terminating resistors of GOT .............................. 1-28
[V]
VIDEO/RGB CONNECTION ............................... 12-1
VNC(R) SERVER CONNECTION ....................... 11-1
Index-2
REVISIONS
* The manual number is given on the bottom left of the back cover.
REVISIONS - 1
Print Date * Manual Number Revision
This manual confers no industrial property rights or any rights of any other kind, nor does it confer any patent licenses.
Mitsubishi Electric Corporation cannot be held responsible for any problems involving industrial property rights which may occur as a result
of using the contents noted in this manual.
© 2009 MITSUBISHI ELECTRIC CORPORATION
REVISIONS - 2
WARRANTY
Please check the following product warranty details before using this product.
■1. Gratis Warranty Term and Gratis Warranty Range
If any faults or defects (hereinafter "Failure") found to be the responsibility of Mitsubishi occurs during use of the product within the
gratis warranty term, the product shall be repaired at no cost via the sales representative or Mitsubishi Service Company.
However, if repairs are required onsite at domestic or overseas location, expenses to send an engineer will be solely at the customer's
discretion.
Mitsubishi shall not be held responsible for any re-commissioning, maintenance, or testing on-site that involves replacement of the
failed module.
(1) Gratis Warranty Term
The gratis warranty term of the product shall be for thirty-six (36) months after the date of purchase or delivery to a designated
place.
Note that after manufacture and shipment from Mitsubishi, the maximum distribution period shall be six (6) months, and the longest
gratis warranty term after manufacturing shall be forty-two (42) months.
The gratis warranty term of repair parts shall not exceed the gratis warranty term before repairs.
(2) Gratis Warranty Range
(a) The customer shall be responsible for the primary failure diagnosis unless otherwise specified.
If requested by the customer, Mitsubishi Electric Corporation or its representative firm may carry out the primary failure
diagnosis at the customer’s expense.
The primary failure diagnosis will, however, be free of charge should the cause of failure be attributable to Mitsubishi Electric
Corporation.
(b) The range shall be limited to normal use within the usage state, usage methods, and usage environment, etc., which follow the
conditions and precautions, etc., given in the instruction manual, user's manual and caution labels on the product.
(c) Even within the gratis warranty term, repairs shall be charged in the following cases.
• Failure occurring from inappropriate storage or handling, carelessness or negligence by the user. Failure caused by the user's
hardware or software design.
• Failure caused by unapproved modifications, etc., to the product by the user.
• When the Mitsubishi product is assembled into a user's device, Failure that could have been avoided if functions or structures,
judged as necessary in the legal safety measures the user's device is subject to or as necessary by industry standards, had
been provided.
• Failure that could have been avoided if consumable parts designated in the instruction manual had been correctly serviced or
replaced.
• Replacing consumable parts such as a battery, backlight, and fuse.
• Failure caused by external irresistible forces such as fires or abnormal voltages, and Failure caused by force majeure such as
earthquakes, lightning, wind and water damage.
• Failure caused by reasons that could not be predicted by scientific technology standards at the time of shipment from
Mitsubishi.
• Any other failure found not to be the responsibility of Mitsubishi or that admitted not to be so by the user.
■2. Onerous repair term after discontinuation of production
(1) Mitsubishi shall accept onerous product repairs for seven (7) years after production of the product is discontinued.
Discontinuation of production shall be notified with Mitsubishi Technical Bulletins, etc.
(2) Mitsubishi shall not accept a request for product supply (including spare parts) after production is discontinued.
■3. Overseas service
Overseas, repairs shall be accepted by Mitsubishi's local overseas FA Center.
Note that the repair conditions at each FA Center may differ.
■4. Exclusion of loss in opportunity and secondary loss from warranty liability
Regardless of the gratis warranty term, Mitsubishi shall not be liable for compensation to:
(1) Damages caused by any cause found not to be the responsibility of Mitsubishi.
(2) Loss in opportunity, lost profits incurred to the user by Failures of Mitsubishi products.
(3) Special damages and secondary damages whether foreseeable or not, compensation for accidents, and compensation for
damages to products other than Mitsubishi products.
(4) Replacement by the user, maintenance of on-site equipment, start-up test run and other tasks.
■5. Changes in product specifications
The specifications given in the catalogs, manuals, or technical documents are subject to change without prior notice.
■6. Product application
(1) In using the Mitsubishi graphic operation terminal, the usage conditions shall be that the application will not lead to a major accident
even if any problem or fault should occur in the graphic operation terminal device, and that backup and fail-safe functions are
systematically provided outside of the device for any problem or fault.
(2) The Mitsubishi graphic operation terminal has been designed and manufactured for applications in general industries, etc.
Thus, applications in which the public could be affected such as in nuclear power plants and other power plants operated by
respective power companies, and applications in which a special quality assurance system is required, such as for Railway
companies or Public service shall be excluded from the graphic operation terminal applications.
In addition, applications in which human life or property could be greatly affected, such as in aircraft, medical, railway applications,
incineration and fuel devices, manned transportation equipment, recreation and amusement devices, safety devices, shall also be
excluded from the graphic operation terminal.
Even for the above applications, however, Mitsubishi Electric Corporation may consider the possibility of an application, provided
that the customer notifies Mitsubishi Electric Corporation of the intention, the application is clearly defined and any special quality is
not required, after the user consults the local Mitsubishi representative.
GOT is a registered trademark of Mitsubishi Electric Corporation.
Microsoft, Windows, Windows NT, Windows Server, Windows Vista, and Windows 7 are registered trademarks or trademarks
of Microsoft Corporation in the United States and other countries.
Adobe and Adobe Reader are registered trademarks of Adobe Systems Incorporated.
Pentium and Celeron are registered trademarks of Intel Corporation in the United States and other countries.
Ethernet is a trademark of Xerox Corporation in the United States.
MODBUS is a trademark of Schneider Electric SA.
VNC is a registered trademark of RealVNC Ltd. in the United States and other countries.
Other company and product names herein are either trademarks or registered trademarks of their respective owners.
SH(NA)-080871ENG-V
Series
Connection Manual
(Microcomputers, MODBUS Products, Peripherals) for GT Works3
MODEL SW1-GTD3-U(CON4)-E
MODEL 1D7MC5
CODE
SH(NA)-080871ENG-V(1706)MEE
HEAD OFFICE : TOKYO BUILDING, 2-7-3 MARUNOUCHI, CHIYODA-KU, TOKYO 100-8310, JAPAN
NAGOYA WORKS : 1-14 , YADA-MINAMI 5-CHOME , HIGASHI-KU, NAGOYA , JAPAN
When exported from Japan, this manual does not require application to the
Ministry of Economy, Trade and Industry for service transaction permission.